Business Corporations Act, R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, Business Corporations Act

 

Business Corporations Act

R.S.O. 1990, CHAPTER B.16

Historical version for the period June 17, 2004 to November 3, 2004.

Disclaimer: This consolidation is not an official copy of the law because it is affected by one or more retroactive provisions which have not been incorporated into it. For information about the retroactive provisions, see S.O. 2004, chapter 16, subsection 5 (2) and Schedule D, Table.

Amended by:  1993, c. 16, s. 2; 1994, c. 17, s. 30; 1994, c. 27, s. 71; 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, ss. 20-32; 1999, c. 6, s. 3; 1999, c. 12, Sched. F, ss. 1-9; 2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3; 2000, c. 42, Sched., ss. 1, 2; 2001, c. 8, ss. 1, 2; 2001, c. 9, Sched. D, s. 2; 2001, c. 23, s. 6; 2002, c. 8, Sched. I, s. 2; 2002, c. 22, s. 8; 2002, c. 24, Sched. B, ss. 25, 27; 2004, c. 8, s. 46, Table.

Skip Table of Contents

CONTENTS

PART I
DEFINITIONS, INTERPRETATION AND APPLICATION

1.

Definitions and interpretation

2.

Application

PART II
INCORPORATION

3.

Incorporation

3.1

Professional corporations

3.2

Application of Act to professional corporations

3.3

Consequences of occurrence of certain events

3.4

No limit on professional liability

4.

Articles of incorporation

5.

Contents of articles

6.

Certificate of incorporation

7.

Certificate of incorporation

8.

Assignment of number

9.

Name prohibition

10.

Restrictions on corporate name

11.

Unauthorized use of “Limited”, etc.

12.

Change of name if objectionable

13.

Corporate seal

14.

Registered office

15.

Corporate powers

16.

Capacity to act outside Ontario

17.

Corporate power

18.

Where notice is not deemed

19.

Indoor management rule

20.

Financial assistance by corporation

21.

Contract prior to corporate existence

PART III
CORPORATE FINANCE

22.

Shares

23.

Issuance of shares

24.

Separate capital account

25.

Special shares in series

26.

Pre-emptive rights

27.

Conversion privileges, etc.

28.

Subsidiaries not to hold shares of holding bodies corporate

29.

Exception to s. 28

30.

Purchase of issued shares permitted

31.

Where s. 30 (2) does not apply

32.

Redemption of shares

33.

Donation of share

34.

Reduction of liability re unpaid share: stated capital

35.

Amount deducted from account upon purchase, etc., of shares

36.

Contract with corporation re purchase of its shares

37.

Commission on sale of shares

38.

Declaration of dividends

39.

Corporations with wasting assets

40.

Lien on share

41.

Shares personal property

42.

Restrictions on transfer, etc.

43.

Bearer debt obligations

44.

Irredeemable debt obligation

PART IV
SALE OF RESTRICTED SHARES

45.

Restricted shares held in contravention — sale by corporation

PART V
INDENTURE TRUSTEES

46.

Trust indentures

47.

Duty of trustee

48.

Conflict of interest

49.

Evidence of compliance

50.

Trustee not to be receiver

51.

Notice of events of default

52.

Where list of debt obligation holders to be furnished

PART VI
INVESTMENT SECURITIES

53.

Definitions and interpretation

54.

Share certificates

55.

Signing of share certificates

56.

Contents of share certificate

57.

Certificate for fractional share or scrip certificates

58.

Overissue

59.

Evidence

60.

Selection of laws

61.

Form of transfer

62.

Position of issuer re guarantor

63.

Notice of terms of security

64.

Notice of defect

65.

Unauthorized signatures on issue

66.

Completion of blanks

67.

Effect of registration

68.

Warranties in issue

69.

Rights acquired by purchasers

70.

Notice of adverse claim

71.

Warranties

72.

Absence of endorsement

73.

Endorsement

74.

Delivery necessary

75.

Endorsement of security in bearer form

76.

Effect of unauthorized endorsement

77.

Guarantee of signature

78.

Delivery of a security

79.

Duty of seller to deliver

80.

Action for wrongful transfer

81.

Transferor’s duty to provide requisites for registration of transfer

82.

When seizure effective

83.

Transfer by agent in good faith not conversion

84.

Contract for sale

85.

Transfer through clearing agency

86.

Duty of issuer to register transfer

87.

Assurances required by issuer

88.

Notice to issuer of adverse claim

89.

Liability of issuer

90.

Loss, etc., of securities

91.

Duty of agents for issuer

PART VII
SHAREHOLDERS

92.

Shareholders’ liability limited

93.

Place of meetings

94.

Shareholders’ meetings

95.

Date for determining shareholders

96.

Notice of shareholders’ meetings

97.

Shareholders’ meeting

98.

Waiving notice

99.

Proposal

100.

List of shareholders

101.

Quorum

102.

Voting rights

103.

Manner of voting

104.

Resolution in lieu of meeting

105.

Requisition for shareholders meeting

106.

Requisition by court

107.

Determination of controversy

108.

Agreement between shareholders

PART VIII
PROXIES

109.

Definitions

110.

Proxies

111.

Mandatory solicitation of proxy

112.

Information circular

113.

Exemption order re ss. 111, 112

114.

Proxyholder

PART IX
DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

115.

Directors

116.

By-laws by resolution

117.

First directors meeting

118.

Qualifications of directors

119.

First directors

120.

Cumulative voting for directors

121.

When director ceases to hold office

122.

Removal of directors

123.

Entitlement of director

124.

Vacancies

125.

Change in number of directors

126.

Place of meetings and quorum

127.

Delegation by directors

128.

Validity of acts of directors and officers

129.

Resolutions in writing

130.

Liability of directors

131.

Directors’ liability to employees for wages

132.

Disclosure: conflict of interest

133.

Officers

134.

Standards of care, etc., of directors, etc.

135.

Consent of director at meeting

136.

Indemnification of directors

137.

Remuneration of directors

PART X
INSIDER LIABILITY

138.

Insider liability

PART XI
BOOKS AND RECORDS

139.

Records

140.

Records, duties of corporation

141.

Securities register

142.

Transfer agents

143.

Registers, general

144.

Records open to examination by directors

145.

Examination of records by shareholders and creditors

146.

List of shareholders

147.

Trafficking in lists

PART XII
AUDITORS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

148.

Exemption from audit requirements

149.

Auditors

150.

Resignation of auditor

151.

Auditor’s attendance at shareholders’ meetings

152.

Disqualification as auditor

153.

Examination by auditor

154.

Information to be laid before annual meeting

155.

Preparation of financial statements

156.

Filing by offering corporation

157.

Financial statements of subsidiaries

158.

Audit committee

159.

Approval by directors

160.

Interim financial statement

PART XIII
INVESTIGATION

161.

Investigation

162.

Matters that may be covered by court order

163.

Powers of inspector

164.

Rights at hearing

165.

Privileged statements

166.

Solicitor-client privilege

167.

Inquiries by Director

PART XIV
FUNDAMENTAL CHANGES

168.

Amendments

169.

Proposal to amend articles

170.

Authorization for variation of rights of special shareholders

171.

Articles of amendment

172.

Certificate of amendment

173.

Restated articles of incorporation

174.

Amalgamation

175.

Amalgamation agreement

176.

Submission of amalgamation agreement

177.

Amalgamations involving holding corporation

178.

Articles of amalgamation

179.

Effect of certificate

180.

Articles of continuance

181.

Transfer of Ontario corporations

181.1

Continuation as co-operative corporation

182.

Arrangement

183.

Articles of arrangement sent to Director

184.

Borrowing powers

185.

Rights of dissenting shareholders

186.

Reorganization

PART XV
COMPULSORY ACQUISITIONS

187.

Application and definitions

188.

Take-over or issuer bid

189.

Where corporation required to acquire securities

190.

Going private transaction

PART XVI
LIQUIDATION AND DISSOLUTION

191.

Definition

192.

Application of ss. 193-205

193.

Voluntary winding up

194.

Inspectors

195.

Vacancy in office of liquidator

196.

Removal of liquidator

197.

Commencement of winding up

198.

Corporation to cease business

199.

No proceedings against corporation after voluntary winding up except by leave

200.

List of contributories and calls

201.

Meetings of corporation during winding up

202.

Arrangements with creditors

203.

Power to compromise with debtors and contributories

204.

Power to accept shares, etc., as consideration for sale of property to another body corporate

205.

Account of voluntary winding up to be made by liquidator to a meeting

206.

Application of ss. 207-218

207.

Winding up by court

208.

Who may apply

209.

Power of court

210.

Appointment of liquidator

211.

Removal of liquidator

212.

Costs and expenses

213.

Commencement of winding up

214.

Proceedings in winding up after order

215.

Orders following winding-up order

216.

Proceedings against corporation after court winding up

217.

Provision for discharge and distribution by the court

218.

Order for dissolution

219.

Application of ss. 220-236

220.

Where no liquidator

221.

Consequences of winding up

222.

Payment of costs and expenses

223.

Powers of liquidators

224.

Acts by more than one liquidator

225.

Nature of liability of contributory

226.

Liability in case of contributory’s death

227.

Deposit of money

228.

Proving claim

229.

Application for direction

230.

Examination of persons as to estate

231.

Proceedings by shareholders

232.

Rights conferred by Act to be in addition to other powers

233.

Stay of winding up proceedings

234.

Where creditor unknown

235.

Where shareholder unknown

236.

Disposal of records, etc., after winding up

237.

Voluntary dissolution

238.

Articles of dissolution where corporation active

239.

Certificate of dissolution

240.

Cancellation of certificate, etc., by Director

241.

Notice of dissolution

242.

Actions after dissolution

243.

Liability of shareholders to creditors

244.

Forfeiture of undisposed property

PART XVII
REMEDIES, OFFENCES AND PENALTIES

245.

Definitions

246.

Derivative actions

247.

Court order

248.

Oppression remedy

249.

Discontinuance and settlement

250.

Rectifying error in entering, etc., name

251.

Notice of refusal to file

252.

Appeal from Director

253.

Orders for compliance

254.

Application made without notice

255.

Appeal

256.

Offences

257.

Consent

258.

Offence

259.

Limitation

260.

Information containing more than one offence

261.

Civil remedy not affected

PART XVIII
GENERAL

262.

Notice to directors or shareholders

263.

Notice to corporation

264.

Waiver of notice and abridgement of times

265.

Delegation of powers and duties

266.

Certificate that may be signed by directors, etc.

267.

Copy of document acceptable

268.

Proof by affidavit

270.

Examination, etc., of documents

271.

Appeal from Commission

271.1

Powers of Minister

272.

Regulations

273.

Where articles to be sent to Director

273.1

Electronic filers

273.2

Fax filing

274.

No certificate if corporation in default

275.

Where error in respect of certificate

276.

Records

277.

Deemed amendment

278.

Appointment of Director

PART I
DEFINITIONS, interpretation AND APPLICATION

Definitions and interpretation

1. (1) In this Act,

“affairs” means the relationships among a corporation, its affiliates and the shareholders, directors and officers of such bodies corporate but does not include the business carried on by such bodies corporate; (“affaires internes”)

“affiliate” means an affiliated body corporate within the meaning of subsection (4); (“membre du même groupe”)

“articles” means the original or restated articles of incorporation, articles of amendment, articles of amalgamation, articles of arrangement, articles of continuance, articles of dissolution, articles of reorganization, articles of revival, letters patent, supplementary letters patent, a special Act and any other instrument by which a corporation is incorporated; (“statuts”)

“associate”, where used to indicate a relationship with any person, means,

(a) any body corporate of which the person beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, voting securities carrying more than 10 per cent of the voting rights attached to all voting securities of the body corporate for the time being outstanding,

(b) any partner of that person,

(c) any trust or estate in which the person has a substantial beneficial interest or as to which the person serves as trustee or in a similar capacity,

(d) the person’s spouse or same-sex partner or any relative of the person, where the spouse, same-sex partner or relative has the same home as the person, or

(e) any relative of the spouse or same-sex partner of the person where the relative has the same home as the person; (“personne qui a un lien”)

“auditor” includes a partnership of auditors; (“vérificateur”)

“beneficial interest” or “beneficial ownership” includes ownership through a trustee, legal representative, agent or other intermediary; (“intérêt bénéficiaire”, “propriété bénéficiaire”)

“body corporate” means any body corporate with or without share capital and whether or not it is a corporation to which this Act applies; (“personne morale”)

“certified copy” means,

(a) in relation to a document of a corporation, a copy of the document certified to be a true copy by an officer thereof,

(b) in relation to a document issued by a court, a copy of the document certified to be a true copy under the seal of the court and signed by the registrar thereof,

(c) in relation to a document in the custody of the Director, a copy of the document certified to be a true copy by the Director and signed by the Director or by such officer of the Ministry as is designated by the regulations; (“copie certifiée conforme”)

“Commission” means the Ontario Securities Commission; (“Commission”)

“corporation” means a body corporate with share capital to which this Act applies; (“société”, “société par actions”)

“corporation number” means the number assigned by the Director to a corporation in accordance with subsection 8 (1) and “number” in relation to a corporation means the corporation number of that corporation; (“numéro de la société”, “numéro”)

“court” means the Superior Court of Justice; (“tribunal”)

“day” means a clear day and a period of days shall be deemed to commence the day following the event that began the period and shall be deemed to terminate at midnight of the last day of the period except that if the last day of the period falls on a Sunday or holiday the period shall terminate at midnight of the day next following that is not a Sunday or holiday; (“jour”)

“debt obligation” means a bond, debenture, note or other similar obligation or guarantee of such an obligation of a body corporate, whether secured or unsecured; (“titre de créance”)

“Director” means the Director appointed under section 278; (“directeur”)

“director” means a person occupying the position of director of a corporation by whatever name called, and “directors” and “board of directors” include a single director; (“administrateur”)

“electronic signature” means an identifying mark or process that is,

(a) created or communicated using telephonic or electronic means,

(b) attached to or associated with a document or other information, and

(c) made or adopted by a person to associate the person with the document or other information, as the case may be; (“signature électronique”)

“endorse” includes imprinting a stamp on the face of articles or other document sent to the Director; (“apposer”)

“financial statement” means a financial statement referred to in section 154; (“état financier”)

“incorporator” means a person who signs articles of incorporation; (“fondateur”)

“individual” means a natural person, but does not include a partnership, unincorporated association, unincorporated syndicate, unincorporated organization, trust, or a natural person in his or her capacity as trustee, executor, administrator or other legal representative; (“particulier”)

“interim financial statement” means a financial statement referred to in section 160; (“état financier périodique”)

“liability” includes a debt of a corporation arising under section 36, subsection 185 (29) or clause 248 (3) (f) or (g); (“passif”)

“Minister” means the Minister of Consumer and Business Services or such other member of the Executive Council to whom the administration of this Act may be assigned; (“ministre”)

“Ministry” means the Ministry of the Minister; (“ministère”)

“non-resident corporation” means a corporation incorporated in Canada before the 27th day of April, 1965, and that is not deemed to be resident in Canada for the purposes of the Income Tax Act (Canada) by subsection 250 (4) of that Act; (“société non résidente”)

“number name” means the name of a corporation that consists only of its corporation number followed by the word “Ontario” and one of the words or abbreviations provided for in subsection 10 (1); (“dénomination sociale numérique”)

“offering corporation” means a corporation that is offering its securities to the public within the meaning of subsection (6) and that is not the subject of an order of the Commission deeming it to have ceased to be offering its securities to the public; (“société faisant appel au public”)

“officer” means an officer designated under section 133 and includes the chair of the board of directors, a vice-chair of the board of directors, the president, a vice-president, the secretary, an assistant secretary, the treasurer, an assistant treasurer and the general manager of a corporation, and any other individual designated an officer of a corporation by by-law or by resolution of the directors or any other individual who performs functions for a corporation similar to those normally performed by an individual occupying any such office; (“dirigeant”)

“ordinary resolution” means a resolution that is submitted to a meeting of the shareholders of a corporation and passed, with or without amendment, at the meeting by at least a majority of the votes cast; (“résolution ordinaire”)

“person” includes an individual, sole proprietorship, partnership, unincorporated association, unincorporated syndicate, unincorporated organization, trust, body corporate, and a natural person in his or her capacity as trustee, executor, administrator, or other legal representative; (“personne”)

“personal representative”, where used with reference to holding shares in that capacity, means an executor, administrator, guardian, tutor, trustee, receiver or liquidator or the committee of or curator to a mentally incompetent person; (“ayant droit”)

“prescribed” means prescribed by the regulations; (“prescrit”)

“redeemable share” means a share issued by a corporation,

(a) that the corporation may purchase or redeem upon the demand of the corporation, or

(b) that the corporation is required by its articles to purchase or redeem at a specified time or otherwise upon the demand of a shareholder; (“action rachetable”)

“registered office” means the office of a corporation located at the address specified in its articles or in the notice most recently filed by the corporation under subsection 14 (3); (“siège social”)

“regulations” means the regulations made under this Act; (“règlements”)

“related person”, where used to indicate a relationship with any person, means,

(a) any spouse, same-sex partner, son or daughter of that person,

(b) any relative of the person or of the person’s spouse or same-sex partner, other than an individual referred to in clause (a), who has the same home as the person, or

(c) any body corporate of which the person and any of the persons referred to in clause (a) or (b) or the partner or employer of the person, or any combination, beneficially own, directly or indirectly, voting securities carrying more than 50 per cent of the voting rights attached to all voting securities of the body corporate for the time being outstanding; (“personne liée”)

“resident Canadian” means an individual who is,

(a) a Canadian citizen ordinarily resident in Canada,

(b) a Canadian citizen not ordinarily resident in Canada who is a member of a prescribed class of persons, or

(c) a permanent resident within the meaning of the Immigration Act (Canada) and ordinarily resident in Canada; (“résident canadien”)

“same-sex partner” means a person of the same sex with whom the person is living in a conjugal relationship outside marriage; (“partenaire de même sexe”)

“security” means a share of any class or series of shares or a debt obligation of a body corporate and includes a certificate evidencing such a share or debt obligation; (“valeur mobilière”)

“security interest” means an interest in or charge upon the property of a body corporate by way of mortgage, hypothec, pledge or otherwise, to secure payment of a debt or performance of any other obligation of the body corporate; (“sûreté”)

“send” includes deliver or mail; (“envoyer”)

“senior officer” means,

(a) the chair of the board of directors, a vice-chair of the board of directors, the president, a vice-president, the secretary, the treasurer or the general manager of a corporation or any other individual who performs functions for a corporation similar to those normally performed by an individual occupying any such office, and

(b) each of the five highest paid employees of a corporation, including any individual referred to in clause (a); (“cadre dirigeant”)

“series”, in relation to shares, means a division of a class of shares; (“série”)

“special resolution” means a resolution that is,

(a) submitted to a special meeting of the shareholders of a corporation duly called for the purpose of considering the resolution and passed, with or without amendment, at the meeting by at least two-thirds of the votes cast, or

(b) consented to in writing by each shareholder of the corporation entitled to vote at such a meeting or the shareholder’s attorney authorized in writing; (“résolution spéciale”)

“spouse” means a person of the opposite sex to whom the person is married or with whom the person is living in a conjugal relationship outside marriage; (“conjoint”)

“telephonic or electronic means” means telephone calls or messages, facsimile messages, electronic mail, transmission of data or information through automated touch-tone telephone systems, transmission of data or information through computer networks, any other similar means or any other prescribed means; (“voie téléphonique ou électronique”)

“unanimous shareholder agreement” means an agreement described in subsection 108 (2) or a declaration of a shareholder described in subsection 108 (3); (“convention unanime des actionnaires”)

“voting security” means any security other than a debt obligation of a body corporate carrying a voting right either under all circumstances or under some circumstances that have occurred and are continuing; (“valeur mobilière avec droit de vote”)

“warrant” means any certificate or other document issued by a corporation as evidence of conversion privileges or options or rights to acquire securities of the corporation. (“bon de souscription”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (1); 1999, c. 6, s. 3; 1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 1; 2001, c. 9, Sched. D, s. 2 (1, 2).

Interpretation: subsidiary body corporate

(2) For the purposes of this Act, a body corporate shall be deemed to be a subsidiary of another body corporate if, but only if,

(a) it is controlled by,

(i) that other, or

(ii) that other and one or more bodies corporate each of which is controlled by that other, or

(iii) two or more bodies corporate each of which is controlled by that other; or

(b) it is a subsidiary of a body corporate that is that other’s subsidiary.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (2).

Holding body corporate

(3) For the purposes of this Act, a body corporate shall be deemed to be another’s holding body corporate if, but only if, that other is its subsidiary.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (3).

Affiliated body corporate

(4) For the purposes of this Act, one body corporate shall be deemed to be affiliated with another body corporate if, but only if, one of them is the subsidiary of the other or both are subsidiaries of the same body corporate or each of them is controlled by the same person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (4).

Control

(5) For the purposes of this Act, a body corporate shall be deemed to be controlled by another person or by two or more bodies corporate if, but only if,

(a) voting securities of the first-mentioned body corporate carrying more than 50 per cent of the votes for the election of directors are held, other than by way of security only, by or for the benefit of such other person or by or for the benefit of such other bodies corporate; and

(b) the votes carried by such securities are sufficient, if exercised, to elect a majority of the board of directors of the first-mentioned body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (5).

Offering securities to public

(6) For the purposes of this Act, a corporation is offering its securities to the public only where,

(a) in respect of any of its securities a prospectus or statement of material facts has been filed under the Securities Act or any predecessor thereof, or in respect of which a prospectus has been filed under The Corporations Information Act, being chapter 72 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1960, or any predecessor thereof, so long as any of such securities are outstanding or any securities into which such securities are converted are outstanding; or

(b) any of its securities have been at any time since the 1st day of May, 1967, listed and posted for trading on any stock exchange in Ontario recognized by the Commission regardless of when such listing and posting for trading commenced,

except that where, upon the application of a corporation, the Commission is satisfied, in its discretion, that to do so would not be prejudicial to the public interest, the Commission may order, subject to such terms and conditions as the Commission may impose, that the corporation shall be deemed to have ceased to be offering its securities to the public.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (6); 2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (1, 2).

Execution of documents

(7) Any articles, notice, resolution, requisition, statement or other document required or permitted to be executed by more than one person for the purposes of this Act may be executed in several documents of like form each of which is executed by one or more of such persons, and such documents, when duly executed by all persons required or permitted, as the case may be, to do so, shall be deemed to constitute one document for the purposes of this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 1 (7).

Application

2. (1) This Act, except where it is otherwise expressly provided, applies to every body corporate with share capital,

(a) incorporated by or under a general or special Act of the Parliament of the former Province of Upper Canada;

(b) incorporated by or under a general or special Act of the Parliament of the former Province of Canada that has its registered office and carries on business in Ontario; or

(c) incorporated by or under a general or special Act of the Legislature,

but this Act does not apply to a corporation within the meaning of the Loan and Trust Corporations Act except as provided by that Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 2 (1).

Idem

(2) Despite The Railways Act, being chapter 331 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1950, and subject to subsection 168 (6), this Act applies to a body corporate with share capital that is a company as defined in that Act but that is not engaged in constructing or operating a railway, street railway or incline railway.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 2 (2).

Idem

(3) This Act does not apply to a body corporate with share capital that,

(a) is a company within the meaning of the Corporations Act and has objects in whole or in part of a social nature;

(b) is a corporation to which the Co-operative Corporations Act applies;

(c) is a corporation that is an insurer within the meaning of subsection 141 (1) of the Corporations Act; or

(d) is a corporation to which the Credit Unions and Caisses Populaires Act applies.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 2 (3).

PART II
INCORPORATION

Incorporation

3. (1) Repealed:  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 1.

Incorporation

(2) A corporation may be incorporated under this Act with its powers restricted by its articles to lending and investing money on mortgage of real estate or otherwise, or with its powers restricted by its articles to accepting and executing the office of liquidator, receiver, assignee, trustee in bankruptcy or trustee for the benefit of creditors and to accepting the duty of and acting generally in the winding up of corporations, partnerships and estates, other than estates of deceased persons, and shall not by reason thereof be deemed to be a corporation within the meaning of the Loan and Trust Corporations Act, but the number of its shareholders, exclusive of persons who are in the employment of the corporation, shall be limited by its articles to five, and no such corporation shall issue debt obligations except to its shareholders, or borrow money on the security of its property except from its shareholders, or receive money on deposit or offer its securities to the public.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 3 (2).

Professional corporations

3.1 (1) In this section and in sections 3.2, 3.3 and 3.4,

“member” means a member of a profession governed by an Act that permits the profession to be practised through a professional corporation; (“membre”)

“professional corporation” means a corporation incorporated or continued under this Act that holds a valid certificate of authorization or other authorizing document issued under an Act governing a profession. (“société professionnelle”)  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Professions

(2) Where the practice of a profession is governed by an Act, a professional corporation may practise the profession if,

(a) that Act expressly permits the practice of the profession by a corporation and subject to the provisions of that Act; or

(b) the profession is governed by an Act named in Schedule 1 of the Regulated Health Professions Act, 1991, one of the following Acts or a prescribed Act:

1. Certified General Accountants Association of Ontario Act, 1983.

2. The Chartered Accountants Act, 1956.

3. Law Society Act.

4. Social Work and Social Service Work Act, 1998.

5. Veterinarians Act.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Regulations

(3) The Lieutenant Governor in Council may make regulations prescribing Acts for the purposes of clause (2) (b).  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Application of Act to professional corporations

3.2 (1) This Act and the regulations apply with respect to a professional corporation except as otherwise set out in this section and sections 3.1, 3.3 and 3.4 and the regulations.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Conditions for professional corporations

(2) Despite any other provision of this Act, a professional corporation shall satisfy all of the following conditions:

1. All of the issued and outstanding shares of the corporation shall be legally and beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, by one or more members of the same profession.

2. All officers and directors of the corporation shall be shareholders of the corporation.

3. The name of the corporation shall include the words “Professional Corporation” or “Société professionnelle” and shall comply with the rules respecting the names of professional corporations set out in the regulations and with the rules respecting names set out in the regulations or by-laws made under the Act governing the profession.

4. The corporation shall not have a number name.

5. The articles of incorporation of a professional corporation shall provide that the corporation may not carry on a business other than the practice of the profession but this paragraph shall not be construed to prevent the corporation from carrying on activities related to or ancillary to the practice of the profession, including the investment of surplus funds earned by the corporation.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2; 2002, c. 22, s. 8.

Corporate acts not invalid

(3) No act done by or on behalf of a professional corporation is invalid merely because it contravenes this Act.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Voting agreements void

(4) An agreement or proxy that vests in a person other than a shareholder of a professional corporation the right to vote the rights attached to a share of the corporation is void.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Unanimous shareholder agreements void

(5) A unanimous shareholder agreement in respect of a professional corporation is void unless each shareholder of the corporation is a member of the professional corporation.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Consequences of occurrence of certain events

3.3 (1) Despite any other Act, a professional corporation’s certificate of authorization or other authorizing document remains valid and the corporation does not cease to be a professional corporation despite,

(a) the death of a shareholder;

(b) the divorce of a shareholder;

(c) the bankruptcy or insolvency of the corporation;

(d) the suspension of the corporation’s certificate of authorization or other authorizing document; or

(e) the occurrence of such other event or the existence of such other circumstance as may be prescribed.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2; 2001, c. 8, s. 1 (1); 2001, c. 23, s. 6 (1).

Invalidity of certificate

(2) Subject to the regulations, a certificate of authorization or other authorizing document becomes invalid and the corporation ceases to be a professional corporation on the revocation of the certificate.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2; 2001, c. 8, s. 1 (2).

Regulations

(3) For the purposes of subsection (1), the Lieutenant Governor in Council may make regulations,

(a) prescribing events and circumstances for the purposes of clause (1) (e);

(a.1) providing that, despite clause (1) (a), (b), (c), (d) or (e), whichever applies, a professional corporation’s certificate of authorization or other authorizing document ceases to be valid and the corporation ceases to be a professional corporation because of a failure to meet the terms and conditions described in the regulation;

(a.2) prescribing terms and conditions that apply with respect to the events and circumstances referred to in clauses (1) (a), (b), (c), (d) and (e);

(a.3) prescribing exceptions to the events and circumstances referred to in clauses (1) (a), (b), (c), (d) and (e);

(b) prescribing the manner in which shares of a shareholder are to be dealt with on the occurrence of any event mentioned in clauses (1) (a) to (e), the time within which they are to be dealt with and any other matter related to dealing with the shares.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2; 2001, c. 23, s. 6 (2).

Name change

(4) A corporation that ceases to be a professional corporation shall change its name to remove from it the word “professional” or “professionnelle”.  2001, c. 8, s. 1 (3).

No limit on professional liability

3.4 (1) Subsection 92 (1) shall not be construed as limiting the professional liability of a shareholder of a professional corporation under an Act governing the profession for acts of the shareholder or acts of employees or agents of the corporation.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Deemed acts

(2) For the purposes of professional liability, the acts of a professional corporation shall be deemed to be the acts of the shareholders, employees or agents of the corporation, as the case may be.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Professional liability

(3) The liability of a member for a professional liability claim is not affected by the fact that the member is practising the profession through a professional corporation.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Joint and several liability

(4) A person is jointly and severally liable with a professional corporation for all professional liability claims made against the corporation in respect of errors and omissions that were made or occurred while the person was a shareholder of the corporation.  2000, c. 42, Sched., s. 2.

Same

(5) The liability of a member under subsection (4) cannot be greater than his or her liability would be in the circumstances if he or she were not practising through the professional corporation.  2001, c. 8, s. 2.

Same, partnerships and limited liability partnerships

(6) If a professional corporation is a partner in a partnership or limited liability partnership, the shareholders of the corporation have the same liability in respect of the partnership or limited liability partnership as they would have if the shareholders themselves were the partners.  2001, c. 8, s. 2.

Articles of incorporation

4. (1) One or more individuals or bodies corporate or any combination thereof may incorporate a corporation by signing articles of incorporation and complying with section 6.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 4 (1).

Idem

(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to an individual who,

(a) is less than eighteen years of age;

(b) is of unsound mind and has been so found by a court in Canada or elsewhere; or

(c) has the status of bankrupt.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 4 (2).

Contents of articles

5. (1) Articles of incorporation shall follow the prescribed form and shall set out the prescribed information.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (2).

Director’s consent

(2) If the articles name as first director an individual who is not an incorporator, the corporation shall keep, at its registered office address, the individual’s consent, in the prescribed form, to act as a first director.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 2.

Inspection of consent

(2.1) Upon request and without charge, the corporation shall permit a director, shareholder or creditor to inspect a consent mentioned in subsection (2) during the normal business hours of the corporation and to make a copy.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 2.

Provisions in articles

(3) The articles may set out any provisions permitted by this Act or permitted by law to be set out in the by-laws of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 5 (3).

Where articles, etc., prevail

(4) Subject to subsection (5), if a greater number of votes of directors or shareholders are required by the articles or a unanimous shareholder agreement than are required by this Act to effect any action, the provisions of the articles or of the unanimous shareholder agreement prevail.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 5 (4).

Votes to remove director

(5) The articles shall not require a greater number of votes of shareholders to remove a director than the number specified in section 122.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 5 (5).

Certificate of incorporation

6. An incorporator shall send to the Director articles of incorporation and, upon receipt of the articles, the Director shall endorse thereon, in accordance with section 273, a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of incorporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 6.

Certificate of incorporation

7. A certificate of incorporation is conclusive proof that the corporation has been incorporated under this Act on the date set out in the certificate, except in a proceeding under section 240 to cancel the certificate for cause.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 7.

Assignment of number

8. (1) Every corporation shall be assigned a number by the Director and such number shall be specified as the corporation number in the certificate of incorporation and in any other certificate relating to the corporation endorsed or issued by the Director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 8 (1).

Idem

(2) Where no name is specified in the articles that are delivered to the Director, the corporation shall be assigned a number name.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 8 (2).

Idem

(3) Where, through inadvertence or otherwise, the Director has assigned to a corporation a corporation number or number name that is the same as the number or name of any other corporation previously assigned, the Director may, without holding a hearing, issue a certificate of amendment to the articles of the corporation changing the number or name assigned to the corporation and, upon the issuance of the certificate of amendment, the articles are amended accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 8 (3).

Idem

(4) Where for any reason the Director has endorsed a certificate on articles that sets out the corporation number incorrectly, the Director may substitute a corrected certificate that bears the date of the certificate it replaces.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 8 (4).

Idem

(5) The file number that was assigned to each corporation by the Minister prior to the 29th day of July, 1983 shall be deemed to be that corporation’s number.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 8 (5).

Name prohibition

9. (1) Subject to subsection (2), a corporation shall not have a name,

(a) that contains a word or expression prohibited by the regulations;

(b) that is the same as or, except where a number name is proposed, similar to,

(i) the name of a known,

(A) body corporate,

(B) trust,

(C) association,

(D) partnership,

(E) sole proprietorship, or

(F) individual,

whether in existence or not, or

(ii) the known name under which any body corporate, trust, association, partnership, sole proprietorship, or individual, carries on business or identifies himself, herself or itself,

if the use of that name would be likely to deceive; or

(c) that does not meet the requirements prescribed by the regulations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 9 (1).

Exception to subs. (1)

(2) A corporation may have a name described in clause (1) (b) upon complying with conditions prescribed by the regulations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 9 (2).

Documents filed

(3) There shall be filed with the Director such documents relating to the name of the corporation as may be prescribed by the regulations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 9 (3).

Restrictions on corporate name

10. (1) The word “Limited”, “Limitée”, “Incorporated”, “Incorporée” or “Corporation” or the corresponding abbreviations “Ltd.”, “Ltée”, “Inc.” or “Corp.” shall be part, in addition to any use in a figurative or descriptive sense, of the name of every corporation, but a corporation may be legally designated by either the full or the abbreviated form.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 10 (1).

Languages

(2) Subject to this Act and the regulations, a corporation may have a name that is in,

(a) an English form only;

(b) a French form only;

(c) a French and English form, where the French and English are used together in a combined form;

(d) a French form and an English form, where the French and English forms are equivalent but are used separately.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (3).

Same

(2.1) A corporation that has a form of name described in clause (2) (d) may be legally designated by the French or English version of its names.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (3).

Other restrictions

(3) For the purposes of subsections (1) and (2), only letters from the Roman alphabet or Arabic numerals or a combination thereof, together with such punctuation marks and other marks as are permitted by regulation, may form part of the name of a corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 10 (3).

Other languages

(4) Subject to the provisions of this Act and the regulations, a corporation may have in its articles a special provision permitting it to set out its name in any language and the corporation may be legally designated by that name.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 10 (4).

Legibility

(5) Despite subsection (4), a corporation shall set out its name in legible characters in all contracts, invoices, negotiable instruments and orders for goods or services issued or made by or on behalf of the corporation and in all documents sent to the Director under this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 10 (5).

Unauthorized use of “Limited”, etc.

11. (1) No person, while not incorporated, shall trade or carry on a business or undertaking under a name in which “Limited”, “Incorporated” or “Corporation” or any abbreviation thereof, or any version thereof in another language, is used.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 11 (1).

Idem

(2) Where a corporation carries on business or identifies itself to the public by a name or style other than as provided in the articles, that name or style shall not include the word “Limited”, “Incorporated” or “Corporation” or any abbreviation thereof or any version thereof in another language.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 11 (2).

Change of name if objectionable

12. (1) If a corporation, through inadvertence or otherwise, has acquired a name contrary to section 9, the Director may, after giving the corporation an opportunity to be heard, issue a certificate of amendment to the articles changing the name of the corporation to a name specified in the certificate and, upon the issuance of the certificate of amendment, the articles are amended accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 12 (1).

Written hearing

(1.1) A hearing referred to in subsection (1) shall be in writing in accordance with the rules made by the Director under the Statutory Powers Procedure Act.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 20.

Failure to perform undertaking

(2) Where an undertaking to dissolve or change its name is given by a corporation and the undertaking is not carried out within the time specified, the Director may, after giving the corporation an opportunity to be heard, issue a certificate of amendment to the articles changing the name of the corporation to a name specified in the certificate and, upon the issuance of a certificate of amendment, the articles are amended accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 12 (2).

Idem

(3) Where an undertaking to dissolve or change its name is given by a person who is not a corporation and the undertaking is not carried out within the time specified, the Director may, after giving the corporation that acquired the name by virtue of such undertaking an opportunity to be heard, issue a certificate of amendment to the articles changing the name of the corporation to a name specified in the certificate and, upon the issuance of the certificate, the articles are amended accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 12 (3).

Corporate seal

13. A corporation may, but need not, have a corporate seal.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 13.

Registered office

14. (1) A corporation shall at all times have a registered office in Ontario at the location specified in its articles, in a resolution made under subsection (3) or in a special resolution made under subsection (4).  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (4); 2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (3).

Idem

(2) The head office of every corporation incorporated prior to the 29th day of July, 1983 shall be deemed to be the registered office of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 14 (2).

Change of location

(3) A corporation may by resolution of its directors change the location of its registered office within a municipality or geographic township.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (5).

Change of municipality, etc.

(4) A corporation may by special resolution change the municipality or geographic township in which its registered office is located to another place in Ontario.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (5).

Validity

(5) Failure to file as set out in subsection (3) or (4) does not affect the validity of the resolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 14 (5).

Corporate powers

15. A corporation has the capacity and the rights, powers and privileges of a natural person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 15.

Capacity to act outside Ontario

16. A corporation has the capacity to carry on its business, conduct its affairs and exercise its powers in any jurisdiction outside Ontario to the extent that the laws of such jurisdiction permit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 16.

Corporate power

17. (1) It is not necessary for a by-law to be passed in order to confer any particular power on the corporation or its directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 17 (1).

Power limited by articles, etc.

(2) A corporation shall not carry on any business or exercise any power that it is restricted by its articles from carrying on or exercising, nor shall the corporation exercise any of its powers in a manner contrary to its articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 17 (2).

Acting outside powers

(3) Despite subsection (2) and subsection 3 (2), no act of a corporation including a transfer of property to or by the corporation is invalid by reason only that the act is contrary to its articles, by-laws, a unanimous shareholder agreement or this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 17 (3).

Where notice is not deemed

18. No person is affected by or is deemed to have notice or knowledge of the contents of a document concerning a corporation by reason only that the document has been filed with the Director or is available for inspection at an office of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 18.

Indoor management rule

19. A corporation or a guarantor of an obligation of a corporation may not assert against a person dealing with the corporation or with any person who has acquired rights from the corporation that,

(a) the articles, by-laws or any unanimous shareholder agreement have not been complied with;

(b) the persons named in the most recent notice filed under the Corporations Information Act, or named in the articles, whichever is more current, are not the directors of the corporation;

(c) the location named in the most recent notice filed under subsection 14 (3) or named in the articles, whichever is more current, is not the registered office of the corporation;

(d) a person held out by a corporation as a director, an officer or an agent of the corporation has not been duly appointed or does not have authority to exercise the powers and perform the duties that are customary in the business of the corporation or usual for such director, officer or agent;

(e) a document issued by any director, officer or agent of a corporation with actual or usual authority to issue the document is not valid or not genuine; or

(f) financial assistance referred to in section 20 or a sale, lease or exchange of property referred to in subsection 184 (3) was not authorized,

except where the person has or ought to have, by virtue of the person’s position with or relationship to the corporation, knowledge to that effect.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 19.

Financial assistance by corporation

20. (1) A corporation may give financial assistance to any person for any purpose by means of a loan, guarantee or otherwise.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Disclosure

(2) Subject to subsection (3), a corporation shall disclose to its shareholders all material financial assistance that it gives to,

(a) a shareholder, a beneficial owner of a share, a director, an officer or an employee of the corporation, an affiliate of the corporation, or an associate of any of them; or

(b) a person for the purpose of, or in connection with, the purchase of a share or a security convertible into or exchangeable for a share issued or to be issued by the corporation or an affiliate of the corporation.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Exception

(3) A corporation is not required to disclose to its shareholders material financial assistance that it gives,

(a) to a person in the ordinary course of business if the lending of money is part of the corporation’s ordinary business;

(b) to a person on account of expenditures incurred or to be incurred on behalf of the corporation;

(c) to its holding body corporate if the corporation is a wholly owned subsidiary of the holding body corporate;

(d) to a subsidiary body corporate of the corporation; or

(e) to employees of the corporation or any of its affiliates in accordance with a plan for the purchase of shares of the corporation or any of its affiliates.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Extent of disclosure

(4) The disclosure that a corporation is required to make under subsection (2) in respect of financial assistance shall include,

(a) a brief description of the financial assistance given, including its nature and extent;

(b) the terms on which the financial assistance was given; and

(c) the amount of the financial assistance initially given and the amount, if any, outstanding.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Time of disclosure

(5) A corporation that is not an offering corporation shall make the disclosure by giving a notice to all shareholders no later than 90 days after giving the financial assistance.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Same, offering corporations

(6) An offering corporation shall make the disclosure,

(a) in each management information circular that it is required to send to its shareholders in respect of the first annual meeting called and held after it gives the financial assistance and in respect of each annual meeting thereafter so long as the financial assistance remains outstanding; or

(b) in a financial statement that the directors are required to place before the shareholders under subsection 154 (1) at the first annual meeting called and held after it gives the financial assistance and at each annual meeting thereafter so long as the financial assistance remains outstanding.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Validity of contract

(7) A contract made by a corporation in contravention of subsection (2), (3), (4), (5) or (6) may be enforced by or against the corporation.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (4).

Contract prior to corporate existence

21. (1) Except as provided in this section, a person who enters into an oral or written contract in the name of or on behalf of a corporation before it comes into existence is personally bound by the contract and is entitled to the benefits thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 21 (1).

Adoption of contract by corporation

(2) A corporation may, within a reasonable time after it comes into existence, by any action or conduct signifying its intention to be bound thereby, adopt an oral or written contract made before it came into existence in its name or on its behalf, and upon such adoption,

(a) the corporation is bound by the contract and is entitled to the benefits thereof as if the corporation had been in existence at the date of the contract and had been a party thereto; and

(b) a person who purported to act in the name of or on behalf of the corporation ceases, except as provided in subsection (3), to be bound by or entitled to the benefits of the contract.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 21 (2).

Non-adoption of contract

(3) Except as provided in subsection (4), whether or not an oral or written contract made before the coming into existence of a corporation is adopted by the corporation, a party to the contract may apply to a court for an order fixing obligations under the contract as joint or joint and several or apportioning liability between the corporation and the person who purported to act in the name of or on behalf of the corporation, and, upon such application, the court may make any order it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 21 (3).

Exception to subs. (1)

(4) If expressly so provided in the oral or written contract referred to in subsection (1), a person who purported to act in the name of or on behalf of the corporation before it came into existence is not in any event bound by the contract or entitled to the benefits thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 21 (4).

PART III
CORPORATE FINANCE

Shares

22. (1) Shares of a corporation shall be in registered form and shall be without nominal or par value.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 22 (1).

Idem

(2) Shares with nominal or par value of a corporation incorporated before the 29th day of July, 1983 shall be deemed to be shares without nominal or par value.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 22 (2).

Rights of shareholders

(3) Where a corporation has only one class of shares, the rights of the holders thereof are equal in all respects and include the rights,

(a) to vote at all meetings of shareholders; and

(b) to receive the remaining property of the corporation upon dissolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 22 (3).

Idem

(4) The articles may provide for more than one class of shares and where they so provide,

(a) the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to the shares of each class shall be set out therein; and

(b) each of the rights set out in subsection (3) shall be attached to at least one class of shares, but both such rights are not required to be attached to any one class.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 22 (4).

Saving provision

(5) Despite subsection (4), the right of the holders of a class of shares to one vote for each share at all meetings of shareholders other than meetings of the holders of another class of shares, or to receive the remaining property of the corporation upon dissolution, need not be set out in the articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 22 (5).

Shares within a class equal

(6) Except as provided in section 25, each share of a class shall be the same in all respects as every other share of that class.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 22 (6).

Issuance of shares

23. (1) Subject to the articles, the by-laws, any unanimous shareholder agreement and section 26, shares may be issued at such time and to such persons and for such consideration as the directors may determine.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 23 (1).

Shares non-assessable

(2) Shares issued by a corporation are non-assessable and the holders are not liable to the corporation or to its creditors in respect thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 23 (2).

Fully-paid shares

(3) A share shall not be issued until the consideration for the share is fully paid in money or in property or past service that is not less in value than the fair equivalent of the money that the corporation would have received if the share had been issued for money.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 23 (3).

Value determined by directors

(4) The directors shall, in connection with the issue of any share not issued for money, determine,

(a) the amount of money the corporation would have received if the share had been issued for money; and

(b) either,

(i) the fair value of the property or past service in consideration of which the share is issued, or

(ii) that such property or past service has a fair value that is not less than the amount of money referred to in clause (a).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 23 (4).

Idem

(5) In determining the value of property or past service, the directors may take into account reasonable charges and expenses of organization and reorganization and payments for property and past service reasonably expected to benefit the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 23 (5).

Interpretation of property

(6) For the purposes of subsection (3) and of subsection 24 (3), a document evidencing indebtedness of a person to whom shares are to be issued, or of any other person not dealing at arm’s length with such person within the meaning of that term in the Income Tax Act (Canada), does not constitute property.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 23 (6).

Separate capital account

24. (1) A corporation shall maintain a separate stated capital account for each class and series of shares it issues.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (1).

Idem

(2) A corporation shall add to the appropriate stated capital account in respect of any shares it issues the full amount of the consideration it receives as determined by the directors which, in the case of shares not issued for money, shall be the amount determined by the directors in accordance with clause 23 (4) (a) or, if a determination is made by the directors in accordance with subclause 23 (4) (b) (i), the amount so determined.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (2).

Exception to subs. (2)

(3) Despite subsection (2) and subsection 23 (3), where a corporation issues shares,

(a) in exchange for,

(i) property of a person who immediately before the exchange does not deal with the corporation at arm’s length within the meaning of that term in the Income Tax Act (Canada), or

(ii) shares of a body corporate that immediately before the exchange or that, because of the exchange, does not deal with the corporation at arm’s length within the meaning of that term in the Income Tax Act (Canada); or

(b) under an agreement referred to in subsection 175 (1) or an arrangement referred to in clause 182 (1) (c) or (d) or to shareholders of an amalgamating corporation who receive the shares in addition to or instead of securities of the amalgamated corporation,

the corporation may, subject to subsection (4), add all or any portion of the consideration it received for the shares to the appropriate stated capital account.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (3).

Addition to stated capital account

(4) On the issue of a share, a corporation shall not add to a stated capital account in respect of the share an amount greater than the amount referred to in subsection (2).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (4).

Stated capital at time of coming into force or continuance

(5) Despite subsection (2), on the 29th day of July, 1983 or at such time thereafter as a corporation has been continued under this Act, as the case may be, the amount in the stated capital account maintained by a corporation in respect of each class or series of shares then issued shall be equal to the aggregate amount paid up on the shares of each such class or series of shares immediately prior thereto, and, after such time, a corporation may, upon complying with subsection (6), add to the stated capital account maintained by it in respect of any class or series of shares any amount it has credited to a retained earnings or other surplus account.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (5).

Additions to stated capital account

(6) Where a corporation proposes to add any amount to a stated capital account that it maintains in respect of a class or series of shares otherwise than under subsection 38 (2), the addition to the stated capital account must be approved by special resolution if,

(a) the amount to be added,

(i) was not received by the corporation as consideration for the issue of shares, or

(ii) was received by the corporation as consideration for the issue of shares but does not form part of the stated capital attributable to such shares; and

(b) the corporation has outstanding shares of more than one class or series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (6).

Idem

(7) Where a class or series of shares of a corporation would be affected by the addition of an amount to any stated capital account under subsection (6) in a manner different from the manner in which any other class or series of shares of the corporation would be affected by such action, the holders of the differently affected class or series of shares are entitled to vote separately as a class or series, as the case may be, on the proposal to take the action, whether or not such shares otherwise carry the right to vote.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (7).

Expressed in one or more currencies

(8) Stated capital accounts of a corporation may be expressed in one or more currencies.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (8).

Reduction in stated capital

(9) A corporation shall not reduce its stated capital or any stated capital account except in the manner provided in this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (9).

Non-application of Act

(10) The provisions of this Act relating to stated capital do not apply to an open-end mutual fund.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (10).

Definition

(11) For the purposes of this section,

“open-end mutual fund” means an offering corporation that carries on only the business of investing the consideration it receives for the shares it issues, and all or substantially all the shares of which are redeemable upon the demand of the holders of such shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 24 (11).

Special shares in series

25. (1) The articles, subject to the limitations set out in them,

(a) may authorize the issue of any class of shares in one or more series and may fix the number of shares in, and determine the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to the shares of, each series; and

(b) may, where the articles authorize the issue of any class of shares in one or more series, authorize the directors to fix the number of shares in, and to determine the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to the shares of each series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 25 (1).

Proportionate abatement

(2) If any amount,

(a) of cumulative dividends, whether or not declared, or declared non-cumulative dividends; or

(b) payable on return of capital in the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of a corporation,

in respect of shares of a series is not paid in full, the shares of the series shall participate rateably with the shares of all other series of the same class in respect of,

(c) all accumulated cumulative dividends, whether or not declared, and all declared non-cumulative dividends; or

(d) all amounts payable on return of capital in the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation,

as the case may be.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 25 (2).

No priority of shares of same class

(3) No rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached to a series of shares authorized under this section shall confer upon the shares of a series a priority in respect of,

(a) dividends; or

(b) return of capital in the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation,

over the shares of any other series of the same class.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 25 (3).

Articles designating special shares

(4) Where, in respect of a series of shares, the directors exercise the authority conferred on them, before the issue of shares of such series, the directors shall send to the Director articles of amendment in the prescribed form designating such series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 25 (4).

Certificate re special shares

(5) On receipt of articles of amendment designating a series of shares under subsection (4), the Director shall endorse thereon, in accordance with section 273, a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of amendment.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 25 (5).

Pre-emptive rights

26. If it is so provided in the articles or a unanimous shareholder agreement, no shares of a class or series shall be issued unless the shares have first been offered to the shareholders of the corporation holding shares of that class or series or of another class or series on such terms as are provided in the articles or unanimous shareholder agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 26.

Conversion privileges, etc.

27. (1) A corporation may issue warrants as evidence of conversion privileges or options or rights to acquire securities of the corporation, and shall set out the conditions thereof,

(a) in certificates evidencing the securities to which the conversion privileges, options or rights are attached; or

(b) in separate certificates or other documents.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 27 (1).

Idem

(2) Conversion privileges and options or rights to purchase securities of a corporation may be made transferable or non-transferable, and options or rights to purchase may be made separable or inseparable from any securities to which they are attached.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 27 (2).

Corporation to maintain sufficient reserve

(3) Where a corporation has granted privileges to convert any securities, other than shares issued by the corporation, into shares of the corporation or has issued or granted options or rights to acquire shares of the corporation and where the articles limit the number of authorized shares, the corporation shall reserve and continue to reserve sufficient authorized shares to meet the exercise of such conversion privileges, options and rights.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 27 (3).

Subsidiaries not to hold shares of holding bodies corporate

28. (1) Except as provided in subsection (2) and sections 29 to 32, a corporation,

(a) shall not hold shares in itself or in its holding body corporate; and

(b) shall not permit any of its subsidiary bodies corporate to hold shares of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 28 (1).

Disposal of shares

(2) A corporation shall cause a subsidiary body corporate of the corporation that holds shares of the corporation to sell or otherwise dispose of those shares within five years from the date the body corporate became a subsidiary of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 28 (2).

Exception to s. 28

29. (1) A corporation may in the capacity of a legal representative hold shares in itself or in its holding body corporate unless it or the holding body corporate or a subsidiary of either of them has a beneficial interest in the shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (1).

Idem

(2) A corporation may permit a subsidiary body corporate to hold shares of the corporation in the capacity of a legal representative unless the corporation or the subsidiary body corporate or a subsidiary of either of them has a beneficial interest in the shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (2).

Idem

(3) A corporation may hold shares in itself or in its holding body corporate by way of security for the purposes of a transaction entered into by it in the ordinary course of a business that includes the lending of money.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (3).

Exception relating to Canadian ownership

(4) A corporation may, for the purpose of assisting the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to qualify under any prescribed Act of Canada or a province or ordinance of a territory to receive licences, permits, grants, payments or other benefits by reason of attaining or maintaining a specified level of Canadian ownership or control, hold shares in itself that,

(a) are not restricted for the purpose of assisting the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to so qualify; or

(b) are shares into which shares held under clause (a) were converted by the corporation that are restricted for the purpose of assisting the corporation to so qualify and that were not previously held by the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (4).

Prohibited transfers

(5) A corporation shall not transfer shares held under subsection (4) to any person unless the corporation is satisfied, on reasonable grounds, that the ownership of the shares as a result of the transfer would assist the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to achieve the purpose set out in subsection (4).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (5).

Where shares are transferred

(6) Where shares held under subsection (4) are transferred by a corporation, subsections 23 (1), (3), (4), (5) and (6), clause 127 (3) (c) and subsection 130 (1) apply, with such modifications as the circumstances require, in respect of the transfer as if the transfer were an issue.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (6).

Transfer not void

(7) No transfer of shares by a corporation shall be void or voidable solely because the transfer is in contravention of subsection (5).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (7).

Corporation holding shares in itself

(8) A corporation holding shares in itself or in its holding body corporate or a subsidiary body corporate of a corporation holding shares of the corporation shall not vote or permit those shares to be voted unless the corporation or subsidiary body corporate, as the case may be,

(a) holds the shares in the capacity of a legal representative; and

(b) has complied with section 49 of the Securities Act where that section is applicable.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 29 (8).

Purchase of issued shares permitted

30. (1) Subject to subsection (2) and to its articles, a corporation may purchase or otherwise acquire any of its issued shares or warrants.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 30 (1).

Where prohibited

(2) A corporation shall not make any payment to purchase or otherwise acquire shares issued by it if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the payment, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) after the payment, the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would be less than the aggregate of,

(i) its liabilities, and

(ii) its stated capital of all classes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 30 (2).

Where s. 30 (2) does not apply

31. (1) Despite subsection 30 (2) but subject to subsection (3) of this section and to its articles, a corporation may purchase or otherwise acquire shares issued by it to,

(a) settle or compromise a debt or claim asserted by or against the corporation;

(b) eliminate fractional shares; or

(c) fulfil the terms of a non-assignable agreement under which the corporation has an option or is obliged to purchase shares owned by a current or former director, officer or employee of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 31 (1).

Idem

(2) Despite subsection 30 (2), a corporation may purchase or otherwise acquire shares issued by it to,

(a) satisfy the claim of a shareholder who dissents under section 185; or

(b) comply with an order under section 248.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 31 (2).

Restriction on payment

(3) A corporation shall not make any payment to purchase or acquire under subsection (1) shares issued by it if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the payment, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) after the payment, the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would be less than the aggregate of,

(i) its liabilities, and

(ii) the amount that would be required to pay the holders of shares who have a right to be paid, on a redemption or in a liquidation, prior to the holders of the shares to be purchased or acquired.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 31 (3).

Redemption of shares

32. (1) Despite subsection 30 (2) and subsection 31 (3), but subject to subsection (2) and to its articles, a corporation may purchase or redeem any redeemable shares issued by it at prices not exceeding the redemption price thereof stated in the articles or calculated according to a formula stated in the articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 32 (1).

Restriction on redemption

(2) A corporation shall not make any payment to purchase or redeem any redeemable shares issued by it if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the payment, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) after the payment, the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would be less than the aggregate of,

(i) its liabilities, and

(ii) the amount that would be required to pay the holders of shares who have a right to be paid, on a redemption or in a liquidation, rateably with or prior to the holders of the shares to be purchased or redeemed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 32 (2).

Donation of share

33. A corporation may accept from any shareholder a share of the corporation surrendered to it as a gift, but may not extinguish or reduce a liability in respect of an amount unpaid on any such share except in accordance with section 34.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 33.

Reduction of liability re unpaid share: stated capital

34. (1) Subject to subsection (4), a corporation may by special resolution,

(a) extinguish or reduce a liability in respect of an amount unpaid on any share; or

(b) reduce its stated capital for any purpose including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, for the purpose of,

(i) distributing to the holders of issued shares of any class or series of shares an amount not exceeding the stated capital of the class or series, or

(ii) declaring its stated capital to be reduced by,

(A) an amount that is not represented by realizable assets, or

(B) an amount otherwise determined in respect of which no amount is to be distributed to holders of issued shares of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (1).

Right to vote where reduction under subs. (1)

(2) Where a class or series of shares of a corporation would be affected by a reduction of stated capital under clause (1) (b) in a manner different from the manner in which any other class or series of shares of the corporation would be affected by such action, the holders of the differently affected class or series of shares are entitled to vote separately as a class or series, as the case may be, on the proposal to take the action, whether or not the shares otherwise carry the right to vote.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (2).

Account to be reduced specified

(3) A special resolution under this section shall specify the stated capital account or accounts from which the reduction of stated capital effected by the special resolution will be made.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (3).

Restriction on reduction

(4) A corporation shall not take any action to extinguish or reduce a liability in respect of an amount unpaid on a share or to reduce its stated capital for any purpose other than the purpose mentioned in sub-subclause (1) (b) (ii) (A) if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the taking of such action, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) after the taking of such action, the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would be less than the aggregate of its liabilities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (4).

Application for order where improper reduction

(5) A creditor of a corporation is entitled to apply to the court for an order compelling a shareholder or other recipient,

(a) to pay to the corporation an amount equal to any liability of the shareholder that was extinguished or reduced contrary to this section; or

(b) to pay or deliver to the corporation any money or property that was paid or distributed to the shareholder or other recipient as a consequence of a reduction of capital made contrary to this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (5).

(6) Repealed:  2002, c. 24, Sched. B, s. 25.

Class action

(7) Where it appears that there are numerous shareholders who may be liable under this section, the court may permit an action to be brought against one or more of them as representatives of the class and, if the plaintiff establishes a claim as creditor, may make an order of reference and add as parties in the referee’s office all such shareholders as may be found, and the referee shall determine the amount that each should contribute towards the plaintiff’s claim, which amount may not, in the case of any particular shareholder, exceed the amount referred to in subsection (5), and the referee may direct payment of the sums so determined.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (7).

Shareholder holding shares in fiduciary capacity

(8) No person holding shares in the capacity of a personal representative and registered on the records of the corporation as a shareholder and therein described as the personal representative of a named person is personally liable under this section, but the person named is subject to all liabilities imposed by this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (8).

s. 130 does not apply

(9) This section does not affect any liability that arises under section 130.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 34 (9).

Amount deducted from account upon purchase, etc., of shares

35. (1) Upon a purchase, redemption or other acquisition by a corporation under section 30, 31, 32, 40 or 185 or clause 248 (3) (f) of shares or fractions thereof issued by it, the corporation shall deduct from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares of which the shares purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired form a part, an amount equal to the result obtained by multiplying the stated capital of the shares of that class or series by the number of shares of that class or series or fractions thereof purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired, divided by the number of issued shares of that class or series immediately before the purchase, redemption or other acquisition.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (1).

Idem

(2) A corporation shall deduct the amount of a payment made by the corporation to a shareholder under clause 248 (3) (g) from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares in respect of which the payment was made.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (2).

Adjustment in stated capital account

(3) A corporation shall adjust its stated capital account or accounts in accordance with any special resolution referred to in subsection 34 (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (3).

Idem

(4) Upon a change under section 168, 186 or 248 of issued shares of a corporation, or upon a conversion of such shares pursuant to their terms, into shares of another class or series, the corporation shall,

(a) deduct from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares changed or converted an amount equal to the result obtained by multiplying the stated capital of the shares of that class or series by the number of shares of that class or series changed or converted, and dividing by the number of issued shares of that class or series immediately before the change or conversion; and

(b) add the result obtained under clause (a) and any additional consideration received pursuant to the change or conversion to the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the class or series of shares into which the shares have been changed or converted.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (4).

Idem

(5) For the purpose of subsection (4) and subject to its articles, where a corporation issues two classes or series of shares and there is attached to each class or series a right to convert a share of the one class or series into a share of the other class or series, the amount of stated capital attributable to a share in either class or series is the amount obtained when the sum of the stated capital of both classes or series of shares is divided by the number of issued shares of both classes or series of shares immediately before the conversion.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (5).

Status of shares purchased, etc.

(6) Shares of any class or series or fractional shares issued by a corporation and purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired by it shall be cancelled or, if the articles limit the number of authorized shares of the class or series, may be restored to the status of authorized but unissued shares of the class.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (6).

Interpretation

(7) For the purposes of this section,

(a) a corporation holding shares in itself as permitted by subsections 29 (1) and (2) shall be deemed not to have purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired the shares; and

(b) a corporation holding shares in itself under clause 29 (4) (a) shall be deemed not to have purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired the shares at the time they were acquired, but,

(i) any of those shares that are held by the corporation at the expiration of two years, and

(ii) any shares into which any of those shares were converted by the corporation and held under clause 29 (4) (b) that are held by the corporation at the expiration of two years after the shares from which they were converted were acquired,

shall be deemed to have been acquired at the expiration of the two years.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (7).

Conversion of shares

(8) Where shares of a class or series are changed under section 168, 186 or 248, or converted pursuant to their terms, into the same or another number of shares of another class or series, such shares become the same in all respects as the shares of the class or series respectively into which they are changed or converted and, if the articles limit the number of shares of either of such classes or series, the number of authorized shares of such class or series is changed and the articles are amended accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 35 (8).

Contract with corporation re purchase of its shares

36. (1) A contract with a corporation providing for the purchase of shares of the corporation by the corporation is specifically enforceable against the corporation except to the extent that the corporation cannot perform the contract without thereby being in breach of section 30 or 31.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 36 (1).

Idem

(2) In any action brought on a contract referred to in subsection (1), the corporation has the burden of proving that performance thereof is prevented by section 30 or 31.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 36 (2).

Idem

(3) Until the corporation has fully performed a contract referred to in subsection (1), the other party to the contract retains the status of a claimant entitled to be paid as soon as the corporation is lawfully able to do so or in a liquidation to be ranked subordinate to the rights of creditors but in priority to the other shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 36 (3).

Commission on sale of shares

37. The directors may authorize the corporation to pay a reasonable commission to any person in consideration of the person’s purchasing or agreeing to purchase shares of the corporation from the corporation or from any other person, or procuring or agreeing to procure purchasers for any such shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 37.

Declaration of dividends

38. (1) Subject to its articles and any unanimous shareholder agreement, the directors may declare and a corporation may pay a dividend by issuing fully paid shares of the corporation or options or rights to acquire fully paid shares of the corporation and, subject to subsection (3), a corporation may pay a dividend in money or property.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 38 (1).

Stock dividend

(2) If shares of a corporation are issued in payment of a dividend, the corporation shall add to the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the shares of the class or series issued in payment of the dividend the declared amount of the dividend stated as an amount of money.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 38 (2).

When dividend not to be declared

(3) The directors shall not declare and the corporation shall not pay a dividend if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the payment, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of,

(i) its liabilities, and

(ii) its stated capital of all classes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 38 (3).

Corporations with wasting assets

39. (1) Despite anything in this Act, a corporation,

(a) that for the time being carries on as its principal business the business of operating a producing mining, gas or oil property owned and controlled by it;

(b) that has at least 75 per cent of its assets being of a wasting character; or

(c) that is incorporated for the purpose of acquiring the assets or a substantial part of the assets of a body corporate and administering such assets for the purpose of converting them into cash and distributing the cash among the shareholders of the corporation,

may declare and pay dividends out of the funds derived from the operations of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 39 (1).

Extent of impairment of capital

(2) The powers conferred by subsection (1) may be exercised even though the value of the net assets of the corporation may be thereby reduced to less than its stated capital of all classes if the payment of the dividends does not reduce the value of its remaining assets to an amount insufficient to meet all the liabilities of the corporation, exclusive of its stated capital of all classes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 39 (2).

Special resolution

(3) The powers conferred by subsection (1) may be exercised only under the authority of a special resolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 39 (3).

Lien on share

40. (1) Subject to subsection 56 (3), the articles or by-laws may provide that the corporation has a lien on a share registered in the name of a shareholder or the shareholder’s legal representative for a debt of that shareholder to the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 40 (1).

Where subs. (1) does not apply

(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to a corporation that has shares listed on a stock exchange recognized by the Commission.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 40 (2).

Enforcement of lien

(3) A corporation may enforce a lien referred to in subsection (1) in accordance with its articles or by-laws.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 40 (3).

Shares personal property

41. The shares of a corporation are personal property.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 41.

Restrictions on transfer, etc.

42. (1) A corporation shall not impose restrictions on the transfer or ownership of shares of any class or series except such restrictions as are authorized by its articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 42 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (6).

No public offer if  transfer, etc., restricted — exceptions

(2) A corporation that has imposed restrictions on the transfer or ownership of its shares of any class or series shall not offer any of its shares to the public unless the restrictions are necessary,

(a) by or under any Act of Canada or Ontario as a condition to the obtaining, holding or renewal of authority to engage in any activity necessary to its undertaking;

(b) for the purpose of achieving or preserving its status as a Canadian body corporate for the purpose of any Act of Canada or Ontario;

(c) to limit to a specified level the ownership of its shares by any prescribed class of person for the purpose of assisting the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to qualify under the Securities Act or similar legislation of a province or territory to obtain, hold or renew registration, or to qualify for membership in a stock exchange in Ontario recognized as such by the Commission; or

(d) to attain or to maintain a specified level of Canadian ownership or control for the purpose of assisting the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to qualify to receive licences, permits, grants, payments or other benefits under any prescribed Act of Canada or a province or ordinance of a territory.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 42 (2); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (6).

Application of subs. (2) (c, d)

(3) Nothing in clause (2) (c) or (d) authorizes a corporation to impose restrictions on the transfer or ownership of shares of any class or series of which any shares are outstanding unless,

(a) in the case of restrictions in respect of a class, the shares of the class; or

(b) in the case of restrictions in respect of a series, the shares of the series,

are already subject to restrictions for the purpose described in clause (2) (c) or (d).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 42 (3); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (6).

Idem

(4) A corporation may,

(a) limit the number of its shares that may be owned; or

(b) prohibit the ownership of its shares,

by any person whose ownership would adversely affect the ability of the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to attain or maintain a level of Canadian ownership or control specified in its articles that equals or exceeds a specified level referred to in clause (2) (d).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 42 (4).

Bearer debt obligations

43. Nothing in this Act prohibits the issue of debt obligations in bearer form.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 43.

Irredeemable debt obligation

44. (1) A condition contained in a debt obligation or in an instrument for securing a debt obligation is not invalid by reason only that the debt obligation is thereby made irredeemable or redeemable only on the happening of a contingency, however remote, or on the expiration of a period, however long.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 44 (1).

Debt obligations

(2) Debt obligations issued, pledged, hypothecated or deposited by a corporation are not redeemed by reason only that the indebtedness evidenced by the debt obligations or in respect of which the debt obligations are issued, pledged, hypothecated or deposited is repaid.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 44 (2).

Idem

(3) Debt obligations issued by a corporation and purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired by it may be cancelled or, subject to any applicable trust indenture or other agreement, may be reissued, pledged or hypothecated to secure any obligation of the corporation then existing or thereafter incurred, and any such acquisition and reissue, pledge or hypothecation is not a cancellation of the debt obligations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 44 (3).

PART IV
SALE OF RESTRICTED SHARES

Restricted shares held in contravention — sale by corporation

45. (1) A corporation that has restrictions on the issue, transfer or ownership of its shares of any class or series in order to assist the corporation or any of its affiliates or associates to qualify,

(a) under the Securities Act or similar legislation of a province or territory, to obtain, hold or renew registration; or

(b) for membership in a stock exchange in Ontario recognized as such by the Commission,

by reason of limiting to a specified level the ownership of its shares by any prescribed class of person or,

(c) under any prescribed Act of Canada or a province or ordinance of a territory, to receive licences, permits, grants, payments or other benefits by reason of attaining or maintaining a specified level of Canadian ownership or control,

may, for a purpose set out in clause (a), (b) or (c) or, in the case of a corporation under clause (c), for the purpose of attaining or maintaining a level of Canadian ownership or control specified in its articles, under such conditions and after giving such notice as may be prescribed, sell, as if it were the owner thereof, any of the restricted shares that are owned, or that the directors determine in such manner as may be prescribed may be owned, contrary to the restrictions.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (1).

Obligations of directors in sale

(2) Where shares are to be sold by a corporation under subsection (1), the directors of the corporation shall select the shares for sale in good faith and in a manner that is not unfairly prejudicial to, and does not unfairly disregard the interests of, the holders of the shares in the restricted class or series taken as a whole.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (2).

Effect of sale

(3) Where shares are sold by a corporation under subsection (1), the owner of the shares immediately prior to the sale shall, by that sale, be divested of the owner’s interest in the shares, and the person who, but for the sale, would be the registered holder of the shares or a person who satisfies the corporation that, but for the sale, such person could properly be treated as the registered holder of the shares under section 67 shall, from the time of the sale, be entitled to receive only the net proceeds of the sale, together with any income earned thereon from the beginning of the month next following the date of the receipt by the corporation of the proceeds of the sale, less any taxes thereon and any costs of administration of a trust fund constituted under subsection (5) in relation thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (3).

s. 67 (4-6) apply

(4) Subsections 67 (4), (5) and (6) apply in respect of the person who is entitled under subsection (3) to receive the proceeds of a sale of shares under subsection (1) as if the proceeds were a security and the person were a registered holder of the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (4).

Proceeds of sale to be trust fund

(5) The proceeds of a sale by a corporation under subsection (1) constitute a trust fund in the hands of the corporation for the benefit of the person entitled under subsection (3) to receive the proceeds of the sale, and any such trust fund may be commingled by the corporation with other such trust funds and shall be invested in such manner as may be prescribed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (5).

Cost of administration

(6) Reasonable costs of administration of a trust fund referred to in subsection (5) may be deducted from the trust fund and any income earned thereon.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (6).

Appointment of trust corporation

(7) Subject to this section, a corporation may transfer any trust fund referred to in subsection (5) and the administration thereof, to a trust corporation in Canada registered as such under the laws of Canada, a province or a territory, and the corporation is thereupon discharged of all further liability in respect of the trust fund.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (7).

Discharge of corporation and trust corporation

(8) A receipt signed by a person entitled under subsection (3) to receive the proceeds of a sale that constitute a trust fund under subsection (5) shall be a complete discharge of the corporation and of any trust corporation to which a trust fund is transferred under subsection (7), in respect of the trust fund and income earned thereon paid to the person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (8).

Forfeit to Crown

(9) A trust fund described in subsection (5) together with any income earned thereon, less any taxes thereon and costs of administration, that has not been claimed, by a person entitled under subsection (3) to receive the proceeds of a sale that constitute the trust fund for a period of ten years after the date of the sale is forfeited to the Crown.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 45 (9).

PART V
INDENTURE TRUSTEES

Trust indentures

46. (1) In this Part,

“event of default” means an event specified in a trust indenture on the occurrence of which,

(a) a security interest constituted by the trust indenture becomes enforceable, or

(b) the principal, interest and other money payable thereunder become or may be declared to be payable before the date of maturity,

but the event is not an event of default until all conditions prescribed by the trust indenture in connection with such event for the giving of notice or the lapse of time or otherwise have been satisfied; (“cas de défaut”)

“trust indenture” means any deed, indenture or other instrument, including any supplement or amendment thereto, made by a body corporate under which the body corporate issues or guarantees debt obligations and in which a person is appointed as trustee for the holders of the debt obligations issued or guaranteed thereunder; (“acte de fiducie”)

“trustee” means any person appointed as trustee under the terms of a trust indenture to which a body corporate is a party and includes any successor trustee, whether or not the person is a trust corporation authorized to carry on business in Ontario. (“fiduciaire”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 46 (1).

Application of this Part

(2) This Part applies to a trust indenture, whether entered into before or after the 29th day of July, 1983, if, in respect of any debt obligations outstanding or guaranteed thereunder or to be issued or guaranteed thereunder, a prospectus or securities exchange issuer or take-over bid circular has been filed under the Securities Act or any predecessor thereof or in respect of which a prospectus has been filed under The Corporations Information Act, being chapter 72 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1960, or any predecessor thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 46 (2).

Resident trustee

(3) The person appointed as trustee under a trust indenture, or at least one of such persons if more than one is so appointed, shall be resident or authorized to do business in Ontario.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 46 (3).

Exemption by Commission

(4) Where, upon the application of a body corporate incorporated otherwise than under the laws of Canada, a province or a territory, the Commission is satisfied that to do so would not be prejudicial to the public interest, the Commission may exempt, subject to such terms and conditions as the Commission may impose, a trust indenture from this Part.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 46 (4).

Duty of trustee

47. (1) A trustee in exercising the trustee’s powers and discharging the trustee’s duties shall,

(a) act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the holders of the debt obligations issued under the trust indenture; and

(b) exercise the care, diligence and skill of a reasonably prudent trustee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 47 (1).

Exculpatory clauses

(2) No term of a trust indenture or of any agreement between a trustee and the holders of debt obligations issued thereunder or between the trustee and the issuer or guarantor shall operate so as to relieve a trustee from the duties imposed upon the trustee in subsection (1).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 47 (2).

Conflict of interest

48. (1) No person shall be appointed as trustee if there is a material conflict of interest between the person’s role as trustee and the person’s role in any other capacity.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 48 (1).

Idem

(2) A trustee shall, within ninety days after becoming aware that a material conflict of interest exists,

(a) eliminate such conflict of interest; or

(b) resign from office.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 48 (2).

Validity not affected

(3) If, despite this section, a trustee has a material conflict of interest, the validity and enforceability of the trust indenture under which the trustee has been appointed, of the security interest constituted by or under such trust indenture and of the securities issued under such trust indenture are not affected in any manner whatsoever by reason only of the existence of such material conflict of interest.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 48 (3).

Replacing trustee

(4) If a trustee contravenes subsection (1) or (2), any interested person may apply to the court for an order that the trustee be replaced, and the court may make an order on such terms as it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 48 (4).

Evidence of compliance

49. (1) An issuer or a guarantor of debt obligations issued or to be issued under a trust indenture, before doing any act referred to in clause (a), (b), (c) or (d), shall furnish the trustee with evidence of compliance with the conditions in the trust indenture relating to,

(a) the issue, certification and delivery of debt obligations under the trust indenture;

(b) the release or release and substitution of property subject to a security interest constituted by the trust indenture;

(c) the satisfaction and discharge of the trust indenture; or

(d) the taking of any other action to be taken by the trustee at the request of or on the application of the issuer or guarantor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 49 (1).

Idem

(2) Evidence of compliance as required by subsection (1) shall consist in each case of,

(a) a statutory declaration or certificate made by a director or an officer of the issuer or guarantor stating that the conditions referred to in that section have been complied with in accordance with the terms of the trust indenture; and

(b) where the trust indenture requires compliance with conditions that are subject to review,

(i) by legal counsel, an opinion, and

(ii) by an auditor or accountant, an opinion or report of the auditor of the issuer or guarantor, or any accountant licensed under the Public Accountancy Act or comparable legislation of the jurisdiction in which the accountant practises, based on the examinations or enquiries required to be made under the trust indenture,

Note:  On a day to be named by proclamation of the Lieutenant Governor, subclause (ii) is amended by the Statutes of Ontario, 2004, chapter 8, section 46, Table by striking out “Public Accountancy Act” and substituting “Public Accounting Act, 2004”.  See:  2004, c. 8, ss. 46, Table; 51 (2).

in each case approved by the trustee, that the conditions have been complied with in accordance with the terms of the trust indenture.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 49 (2).

Idem

(3) The evidence of compliance referred to in subsection (2) shall include a statement by the person giving the evidence,

(a) declaring that the person has read and understands the conditions of the trust indenture described in subsection (1);

(b) describing the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the person based the statutory declaration, certificate, opinion or report; and

(c) declaring that the person has made such examination or investigation as the person believes necessary to enable the person to make the statements or give the opinions contained or expressed therein.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 49 (3).

Certificate of issuer or guarantor

(4) At least once in each twelve-month period beginning on the date debt obligations are first issued under the trust indenture and at any other reasonable time upon the demand of a trustee, the issuer or guarantor of debt obligations issued under a trust indenture shall furnish the trustee with a certificate that the issuer or guarantor has complied with all requirements contained in the trust indenture that, if not complied with, would, with the giving of notice, lapse of time or otherwise, constitute an event of default, or, if there has been failure to so comply, giving particulars thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 49 (4).

Evidence of compliance

(5) Upon the demand of a trustee, the issuer or guarantor of debt obligations issued under a trust indenture shall furnish the trustee with evidence in such form as the trustee may require as to compliance with any condition therein relating to any action required or permitted to be taken by the issuer or guarantor under the trust indenture or as a result of any obligation imposed by the trust indenture.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 49 (5).

Reliance on opinions

(6) A trustee is not in contravention of subsection 47 (1) if the trustee relies in good faith upon statements contained in a statutory declaration, certificate, opinion or report that complies with this Act or the trust indenture.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 49 (6).

Trustee not to be receiver

50. A trustee under a trust indenture and any related person to the trustee shall not be appointed a receiver or receiver and manager or liquidator of the assets or undertaking of the issuer or guarantor of the debt obligations under the trust indenture.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 50.

Notice of events of default

51. (1) The trustee shall be required to give to the holders of debt obligations issued under the trust indenture, within a reasonable time but not exceeding thirty days after the trustee becomes aware of the occurrence thereof, notice of every event of default arising under the trust indenture unless the trustee in good faith determines that the withholding of the notice is in the best interests of the holders of the debt obligations and so advises the issuer or guarantor in writing.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 51 (1).

Idem

(2) Where notice of the occurrence of an event of default under a trust indenture is given under subsection (1) and the default is thereafter cured, notice that the default is no longer continuing shall be given by the trustee to the holders of the debt obligations within a reasonable time, but not exceeding thirty days, after the trustee becomes aware that the default has been cured.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 51 (2).

Where list of debt obligation holders to be furnished

52. (1) Any person, upon payment to a trustee of a reasonable fee therefor, may require the trustee to furnish, within ten days after delivering to the trustee the statutory declaration referred to in subsection (3), a list setting out,

(a) the names and addresses of the registered holders of the outstanding debt obligations;

(b) the principal amount of outstanding debt obligations owned by each such holder; and

(c) the aggregate principal amount of debt obligations outstanding,

as shown on the records maintained by the trustee on the day that the statutory declaration is delivered to the trustee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 52 (1).

Information to be furnished to trustee

(2) Upon the demand of a trustee, the issuer of debt obligations shall furnish the trustee with the information required to enable the trustee to comply with subsection (1).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 52 (2).

Statutory declaration

(3) The statutory declaration required under subsection (1) shall state,

(a) the name and address of the person requiring the trustee to furnish the list and, if the person is a body corporate, the address for service thereof; and

(b) that the list will not be used except as permitted under subsection (5).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 52 (3).

Idem

(4) If the person requiring the trustee to furnish a list under subsection (1) is a body corporate, the statutory declaration required under that subsection shall be made by a director or officer of the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 52 (4).

Use of list

(5) No person shall use a list obtained under this section except in connection with,

(a) an effort to influence the voting of the holders of debt obligations;

(b) an offer to acquire debt obligations; or

(c) any other matter relating to the debt obligations or the affairs of the issuer or guarantor thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 52 (5).

PART VI
INVESTMENT SECURITIES

Definitions and interpretation

53. (1) In this Part,

“adverse claim” includes a claim that a transfer is or would be unauthorized or wrongful or that a particular adverse person is the owner of or has an interest in the security; (“opposition”)

“appropriate person”, when used to refer to a person endorsing a security, means,

(a) the person specified by the security or by special endorsement to be entitled to the security,

(b) where the person so specified is described as a trustee or other fiduciary but is no longer serving in that capacity and even though a successor has been appointed or qualified,

(i) where only one person is so described, that person or that person’s successor, or

(ii) where more than one person is so described, the remaining persons,

(c) where the person so specified is an individual and is without capacity to act by virtue of death, incompetence, infancy or otherwise, the individual’s executor, administrator, committee, guardian or like fiduciary,

(d) where the security or endorsement specified more than one person as joint tenants or with right of survivorship and by reason of death all cannot sign, the survivor or survivors,

(e) a person having the power to sign under the applicable law or controlling instrument, or

(f) to the extent any of the foregoing persons may act through an agent, the person’s authorized agent; (“personne compétente”)

“bearer form” when applied to a security means a security that is payable to bearer according to its terms and not by reason of any endorsement; (“au porteur”)

“broker” means a person engaged full-time or part-time in the business of buying and selling securities and who, in the transaction concerned, acts for or buys a security from or sells a security to a customer; (“courtier”)

“clearing agency” means a person designated as a recognized clearing agency by the Commission; (“agence de compensation”)

“custodian” means a person acting as a custodian for a clearing agency; (“dépositaire”)

“delivery” means voluntary transfer of possession; (“livraison”)

“fiduciary” means a trustee, guardian, committee, curator, tutor, executor, administrator or representative of a deceased person, or any other person acting in a fiduciary capacity; (“représentant”)

“fungible” in relation to securities means securities of which any unit is, by nature or usage of trade, the equivalent of any other like unit; (“fongibles”)

“genuine” means free of forgery or counterfeiting; (“authentique”)

“good faith” means honesty in fact in the conduct of the transaction concerned; (“bonne foi”)

“good faith purchaser” means a purchaser for value, in good faith and without notice of any adverse claim,

(a) who takes delivery of a security certificate in bearer form or order form or of a security certificate in registered form issued to the purchaser or endorsed to the purchaser or endorsed in blank,

(b) in whose name an uncertificated security is registered or recorded in records maintained by or on behalf of the issuer as a result of the issue or transfer of the security to the purchaser, or

(c) who is a transferee or pledgee as provided in section 85; (“acheteur de bonne foi”)

“holder” means a person in possession of a security issued or endorsed to the person or to bearer or in blank; (“détenteur”)

“issuer” means a body corporate,

(a) that is required by this Act to maintain a securities register,

(b) that directly or indirectly creates fractional interests in its rights or property and issues security certificates or uncertificated securities as evidence of the fractional interests,

(c) that places or authorizes the placing of its name on a security certificate, otherwise than as an authenticating trustee, registrar or transfer agent, or that otherwise authorizes the issue of a security certificate or an uncertificated security evidencing a share, participation or other interest in its property or in an enterprise or evidencing its duty to perform an obligation, or

(d) that becomes responsible for or in place of any other person described as an issuer in this Part; (“émetteur”)

“noted conspicuously” and “appearing conspicuously” mean written in such a way that the person against whom words so noted or appearing are to operate ought reasonably to notice them; (“indiqué visiblement”, “apparaissant visiblement”)

“order form” when applied to a security means a security that is payable to the order or assigns of any person therein specified with reasonable certainty or to such person or such person’s order; (“à ordre”)

“overissue” means the issue of securities in excess of any maximum number of securities that the issuer is authorized by its articles or a trust indenture to issue; (“émission excédentaire”)

“proper form” means regular on its face with regard to all formal matters; (“en bonne et due forme”)

“purchaser” means a person who takes by sale, mortgage, hypothec, pledge, issue, reissue, gift or any other voluntary transaction creating an interest in a security; (“acquéreur”)

“registered form” when applied to a security means a security that,

(a) specifies a person entitled to the security or to the rights it evidences, and the transfer of which is capable of being recorded in a securities register, or

(b) bears a statement that it is in registered form; (“nominative”)

“security” means a share, participation or other interest in property, rights or an enterprise of an issuer, or an obligation of an issuer, or any right to acquire such a share, participation, interest or obligation, of a type commonly dealt in upon securities exchanges or markets or commonly recognized as a medium for investment in any area in which it is issued or dealt in; (“valeur mobilière”)

“security certificate” means an instrument in bearer, order or registered form, issued by an issuer evidencing a security; (“certificat de valeur mobilière”)

“transfer” includes transmission by operation of law; (“transfert”)

“trust indenture” means a trust indenture as defined in Part V; (“acte de fiducie”)

“unauthorized”, when used with reference to a signature or an endorsement, means one made without authority, actual, apparent or of any other type and includes a forgery; (“non autorisé”)

“uncertificated security” means a security, not evidenced by a security certificate, the issue and any transfer of which is registered or recorded in records maintained for that purpose by or on behalf of the issuer; (“valeur mobilière non constatée par un certificat”)

“valid” means issued in accordance with the applicable law and the articles of the issuer or validated under section 58. (“valide”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 53 (1).

Application of this Part

(2) This Part does not apply to a promissory note or bill of exchange to which the Bills of Exchange Act (Canada) applies.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 53 (2).

Security as negotiable instrument

(3) Except where its transfer is restricted and noted on a security in accordance with subsection 56 (3), a security is a negotiable instrument.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 53 (3).

Share certificates

54. (1) Every security holder is entitled upon request to a security certificate in respect of the securities held by the security holder that complies with this Act or to a non-transferable written acknowledgement of the security holder’s right to obtain a security certificate from a corporation in respect of the securities of the corporation held by the security holder, but the corporation is not bound to issue more than one security certificate in respect of a security or securities held jointly by several persons, and delivery of a security certificate to one of several joint security holders is sufficient delivery to all.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 54 (1).

Fee

(2) A corporation may charge a fee of not more than $3 for a security certificate issued in respect of a transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 54 (2).

Signing of share certificates

55. (1) A security certificate shall be signed manually by at least one director or officer of the corporation or by or on behalf of a registrar, transfer agent, branch transfer agent or issuing or other authenticating agent of the corporation, or by a trustee who certifies it in accordance with a trust indenture, and any additional signatures required on a security certificate may be printed or otherwise mechanically reproduced thereon.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 55 (1).

Idem

(2) If a security certificate contains a printed or mechanically reproduced signature of a person, the corporation may issue the security certificate even though the person has ceased to be a director or an officer of the corporation, and the security certificate is as valid as if the person were a director or an officer at the date of its issue.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 55 (2).

Where manual signature not required

(3) Despite subsection (1), a manual signature is not required on,

(a) a promissory note that is not issued under a trust indenture;

(b) a scrip certificate;

(c) a security certificate representing a fractional share; or

(d) a warrant.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 55 (3).

Contents of share certificate

56. (1) A corporation shall state upon the face of each share certificate issued by it,

(a) the name of the corporation and the words “Incorporated under the law of the Province of Ontario” or words of like effect;

(b) the name of the person to whom it was issued; and

(c) the number and class of shares and the designation of any series that the certificate represents.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (1).

Idem

(2) Where a corporation is authorized to issue shares of more than one class or series, the corporation shall legibly state on each share certificate issued by it,

(a) the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to the shares of each class and series that exists when the share certificate is issued; or

(b) that the class or series of shares that it represents has rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached thereto and that the corporation will furnish to a shareholder, on demand and without charge, a full copy of the text of,

(i) the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to that share and to each class authorized to be issued and to each series in so far as the same have been fixed by the directors, and

(ii) the authority of the directors to fix the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions of subsequent series, if applicable.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (2).

Where restriction, lien, etc., ineffective

(3) Where a share certificate issued by a corporation or by a body corporate before the body corporate was continued under section 180 is, or becomes, subject to,

(a) a restriction on its transfer other than a restriction referred to in subsection (8);

(b) a lien in favour of the corporation;

(c) a unanimous shareholder agreement; or

(d) an endorsement under subsection 185 (13),

the restriction, lien, agreement or endorsement is ineffective against a transferee of the share who has no actual knowledge of it, unless it or a reference to it is noted conspicuously on the share certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (3).

Notice of restriction

(4) If a body corporate continued under section 180 has outstanding a share certificate issued prior to the date of the certificate of continuance and if the words “private company” or “compagnie fermée” appear on the certificate, those words are deemed to be a notice of a restriction, lien, agreement or endorsement for the purpose of subsection (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (4).

Idem

(5) Where a corporation was incorporated as a private company under The Corporations Act, being chapter 89 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1970, or any predecessor thereof, before the 1st day of January, 1971, the words “private company” or “compagnie fermée” appearing conspicuously on the face of a share certificate issued before the 1st day of January, 1971 shall be deemed to be notice of a restriction on the transfer of the share for the purpose of subsection (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (5).

Par value share certificate

(6) A share certificate issued,

(a) prior to the 29th day of July, 1983 by a corporation; or

(b) prior to the date of the certificate of continuance by a body corporate continued under section 180,

does not contravene this Act merely because the certificate refers to the share or shares represented thereby as having a nominal or par value.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (6).

Information to be furnished by corporation

(7) Where a share certificate issued by a corporation contains the statement mentioned in clause (2) (b), the corporation shall furnish to a shareholder on demand and without charge a full copy of the text of,

(a) the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to that class authorized to be issued and to that series in so far as the same have been fixed by the directors; and

(b) the authority of the directors to fix the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions of subsequent series, if applicable.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (7).

Notice of restrictions

(8) Where the articles of a corporation restrict the issue, transfer or ownership of shares of any class or series for a purpose set out in clause 42 (2) (c) or (d), the restriction or a reference to it shall be noted conspicuously on every share certificate of the corporation evidencing a share that is subject to the restriction if the certificate is issued after the day on which the share becomes subject to the restriction under this Act and any reference to the restriction shall include a statement that the corporation will furnish to a shareholder, on demand and without charge, a full copy of the text of the restriction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (8).

Furnishing text of restrictions

(9) Where a share certificate of a corporation contains a reference to a restriction under subsection (8), the corporation shall furnish to a shareholder, on demand and without charge, a full copy of the text of the restriction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (9).

Omission to note restrictions

(10) The omission to note a restriction or a reference to it under subsection (8) shall not invalidate any share or share certificate and shall not render the restriction ineffective against an owner, holder or transferee of the share or share certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 56 (10).

Certificate for fractional share or scrip certificates

57. (1) A corporation may issue a certificate for a fractional share or may issue in place thereof scrip certificates in bearer form that entitle the holder to receive a certificate for a full share by exchanging scrip certificates aggregating a full share.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 57 (1).

Scrip certificates

(2) The directors may attach conditions to any scrip certificates issued by a corporation, including conditions that,

(a) the scrip certificates become void if not exchanged for a certificate representing a full share before a specified date; and

(b) any shares for which such scrip certificates are exchangeable may, despite any pre-emptive right, be issued by the corporation to any person and the proceeds thereof distributed rateably to the holders of the scrip certificates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 57 (2).

Rights of holder of fractional share

(3) A holder of a fractional share issued by a corporation is not entitled to exercise voting rights or to receive a dividend in respect of the fractional share unless,

(a) the fractional share results from a consolidation of shares; or

(b) the articles of the corporation otherwise provide.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 57 (3).

Rights of holder of scrip certificate

(4) A holder of a scrip certificate is not entitled to exercise voting rights or to receive a dividend in respect of the scrip certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 57 (4).

Overissue

58. (1) The provisions of this Act that validate a security or compel its issue or reissue do not apply to the extent that validation, issue or reissue would result in overissue, but,

(a) if an identical security that does not constitute an overissue is reasonably available for purchase, the person entitled to issue or validation may compel the issuer to purchase and deliver such a security to the person against surrender of the security, if any, that the person holds; or

(b) if a security is not so available for purchase, the person entitled to issue or validation may recover from the issuer the price that the person or the last purchaser for value paid for it with interest from the date of the person’s demand.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 58 (1).

Validation of overissue

(2) When an issuer subsequently amends its articles or a trust indenture to which it is a party to increase any maximum number of securities to a number equal to or in excess of the maximum number of securities previously authorized plus the amount of the securities overissued, the securities so overissued, and any act taken by any person in reliance upon the validity of such overissued securities, are valid from the date of their issue.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 58 (2).

Non-application of ss. 30, 31, 32, 35

(3) A purchase or payment by an issuer under subsection (1) is not a purchase or payment to which section 30, 31, 32 or 35 applies.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 58 (3).

Evidence

59. In an action on a security,

(a) unless specifically denied in the pleadings, each signature on the security or in a necessary endorsement is admitted;

(b) a signature on the security is presumed to be genuine and authorized but, if the effectiveness of the signature is put in issue, the burden of establishing that it is genuine and authorized is on the party claiming under the signature;

(c) if a signature is admitted or established, production of the instrument entitles a holder to recover on it unless the defendant establishes a defence or a defect going to the validity of the security; and

(d) if the defendant establishes that a defence or defect exists, the plaintiff has the burden of establishing that the defence or defect is ineffective against the plaintiff or some person under whom the plaintiff claims.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 59.

Selection of laws

60. (1) The validity of a security and the rights and duties with respect to the registration of a transfer of a security of an issuer that is a corporation or a body corporate incorporated under the laws of Ontario are governed by this Act and the laws of Ontario.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 60 (1).

Idem

(2) The validity of a security and the rights and duties with respect to the registration of a transfer of a security of an issuer that is a body corporate other than a corporation or a body corporate incorporated under the laws of Ontario are governed by the law, including the conflict of law rules, of the jurisdiction in which the body corporate was incorporated.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 60 (2).

Form of transfer

61. (1) Unless otherwise agreed and subject to any applicable law, regulation or stock exchange rule, a person required to deliver securities may deliver any security of the specified issue in bearer form or registered in the name of the transferee or endorsed to the transferee or in blank.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 61 (1).

Default in payment

(2) Where the buyer fails to pay the price as it comes due under a contract of sale, the seller may recover the price,

(a) of any security accepted by the buyer; and

(b) of any security not accepted by the buyer if its resale would be unduly burdensome or there is no readily available market,

but resort to the remedy herein provided for shall not be construed so as to affect or limit any rights or remedies under applicable law.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 61 (2).

Position of issuer re guarantor

62. (1) The obligations and defences of an issuer apply to a guarantor of a security to the extent of the guarantee whether or not such an obligation is noted on the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 62 (1).

Issuer

(2) The person on whose behalf a register of transfers is maintained is an issuer for the purposes of the registration of a transfer under sections 86 to 89.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 62 (2).

Notice of terms of security

63. (1) Even against a purchaser for value and without notice of a defect going to the validity of a security, the terms of a security include those stated on the security and those incorporated therein by reference to another instrument, statute, rule, regulation or order to the extent that the terms so referred to do not conflict with the stated terms, but such a reference is not of itself notice to a purchaser for value of a defect going to the validity of the security, even if the security expressly states that a person accepting it admits such notice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 63 (1).

Validity of security

(2) A security is valid in the hands of a purchaser for value without notice of any defect going to its validity.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 63 (2).

Defence of issuer

(3) Except as provided in section 65, the fact that a security is not genuine is a complete defence even against a good faith purchaser.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 63 (3).

Idem

(4) All other defences of the issuer including non-delivery and conditional delivery of the security are ineffective against a good faith purchaser.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 63 (4).

Idem

(5) Nothing in this section shall be construed to affect the right of a party to a “when, as and if issued” or a “when distributed” contract to cancel the contract in the event of a material change in the character of the security that is the subject of the contract or in the plan or arrangement under which such security is to be issued or distributed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 63 (5).

Notice of defect

64. (1) After an act or event that creates a right to immediate performance of the principal obligation evidenced by the security or that sets a date on or after which the security is to be presented or surrendered for redemption or exchange, a purchaser is deemed to have notice of any defect in its issue or any defence of the issuer,

(a) if the act or event requires the payment of money or the delivery of securities or both on presentation or surrender of the security and such funds or securities are available on the date set for payment or exchange and the purchaser takes the security more than one year after that date; and

(b) if the act or event is not one to which clause (a) applies and the purchaser takes the security more than two years after the date set for surrender or presentation or the date on which such performance became due.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 64 (1).

Revoked call for redemption excepted

(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to a call for redemption that has been revoked.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 64 (2).

Unauthorized signatures on issue

65. An unauthorized signature placed on a security before or in the course of issue is ineffective, except that the signature is effective in favour of a good faith purchaser if the signing has been done by,

(a) an authenticating trustee, registrar, transfer agent or other person entrusted by the issuer with the signing of the security or of similar securities, or their immediate preparation for signing; or

(b) an employee of the issuer or of a person referred to in clause (a) who in the ordinary course of the employee’s duties handles the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 65.

Completion of blanks

66. (1) Where a security contains the signatures necessary to its issue or transfer but is incomplete in any other respect,

(a) any person may complete it by filling in the blanks in accordance with the person’s authority; and

(b) even if the blanks are incorrectly filled in, the security as completed is enforceable by a purchaser who took it for value and without notice of such incorrectness.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 66 (1).

Improper alteration

(2) A completed security that has been improperly altered, even if fraudulently altered, remains enforceable but only according to its original terms.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 66 (2).

Effect of registration

67. (1) An issuer or a trustee defined in subsection 46 (1) may, subject to sections 95, 96 and 100, treat the registered holder of a security as the person exclusively entitled to vote, to receive notices, to receive any interest, dividend or other payments in respect of the security, and otherwise to exercise all the rights and powers of a holder of the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (1).

Representatives, etc., may exercise rights of security holder

(2) Despite subsection (1), an issuer whose articles restrict the right to transfer its securities shall, and any other issuer may, treat a person referred to in clause (a), (b) or (c) as a registered security holder entitled to exercise all the rights of the security holder that the person represents, if that person furnishes evidence as described in subsection 87 (3) to the issuer that the person is,

(a) the executor, administrator, heir or legal representative of the heirs, of the estate of a deceased security holder;

(b) a guardian, committee, trustee, curator or tutor representing a registered security holder who is a minor, an incompetent person or a missing person; or

(c) a liquidator of, or a trustee in bankruptcy for, a registered security holder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (2).

Rights where ownership devolves by operation of law

(3) If a person upon whom the ownership of a security devolves by operation of law, other than a person referred to in subsection (2), furnishes proof of the person’s authority to exercise rights or privileges in respect of a security of the issuer that is not registered in the person’s name, the issuer shall treat the person as entitled to exercise those rights or privileges.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (3).

Corporation has no duty to enforce performance

(4) An issuer is not required to inquire into the existence of, or see to the performance or observance of, any duty owed to a third person by a registered holder of any of its securities or by anyone whom it treats, as permitted or required by this section, as the owner or registered holder thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (4).

Repudiation by minor

(5) If a minor exercises any rights of ownership in the securities of an issuer, no subsequent repudiation or avoidance is effective against the issuer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (5).

Joint holders

(6) Where a security is issued to several persons as joint holders, upon satisfactory proof of the death of one joint holder, the issuer may treat the surviving joint holders as owner of the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (6).

Registration of executor, etc.

(7) Subject to any applicable law of Canada or a province of Canada relating to the collection of taxes, a person referred to in clause (2) (a) is entitled to become a registered holder or to designate a registered holder, if the person deposits with the issuer or its transfer agent,

(a) the original grant of probate or of letters of administration, or a copy thereof certified to be a true copy by,

(i) the court that granted the probate or letters of administration,

(ii) a trust corporation incorporated under the laws of Canada or a province, or

(iii) a lawyer or notary acting on behalf of the person; or

(b) in the case of transmission by notarial will in the Province of Quebec, a copy thereof authenticated under the laws of that Province,

together with,

(c) an affidavit or declaration of transmission made by the person stating the particulars of the transmission;

(d) the security certificate that was owned by the deceased holder,

(i) in case of a transfer to the person, with or without the endorsement of that person, and

(ii) in case of a transfer to any other person, endorsed in accordance with section 73; and

(e) any assurance the issuer may require under section 87.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (7).

Idem

(8) Despite subsection (7), if the laws of the jurisdiction governing the transmission of a security of a deceased holder do not require a grant of probate or of letters of administration in respect of the transmission, a legal representative of the deceased holder is entitled, subject to any applicable law of Canada or a province of Canada relating to the collection of taxes, to become a registered holder or to designate a registered holder, if the legal representative deposits with the issuer or its transfer agent,

(a) the security certificate that was owned by the deceased holder; and

(b) reasonable proof of the governing laws, the deceased holder’s interest in the security and the right of the legal representative or the person the legal representative designates to become the registered holder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (8).

Recording in security register

(9) Deposit of the documents required by subsection (7) or (8) empowers an issuer or its transfer agent to record in a securities register the transmission of a security from the deceased holder to a person referred to in clause (2) (a) or to such person as that person may designate and, thereafter, to treat the person who thus becomes a registered holder as the owner of those securities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 67 (9).

Warranties in issue

68. (1) A person signing a security as authenticating trustee, registrar or transfer agent warrants to a purchaser for value without notice of the particular defect that,

(a) the security is genuine and in proper form;

(b) the person’s own participation in the issue of the security is within the person’s capacity and within the scope of the authorization received by the person from the issuer; and

(c) the person has reasonable grounds to believe that the security is in the form and within the amount the issuer is authorized to issue.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 68 (1).

Idem

(2) Unless otherwise agreed, a person referred to in subsection (1) does not assume any further liability for the validity of a security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 68 (2).

Rights acquired by purchasers

69. (1) Upon delivery of a security, the purchaser acquires the rights in the security that the transferor had or had actual authority to convey except that a purchaser who has been a party to any fraud or illegality affecting the security or who as a prior holder had notice of an adverse claim cannot improve the purchaser’s position by taking from a later good faith purchaser.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 69 (1).

Good faith purchaser

(2) A good faith purchaser in addition to acquiring the rights of a purchaser also acquires the security free of any adverse claim.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 69 (2).

Limited interest

(3) A purchaser of a limited interest acquires rights only to the extent of the interest purchased.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 69 (3).

Notice of adverse claim

70. (1) A purchaser, including a broker for a seller or purchaser, of a security is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim if,

(a) the security has been endorsed “for collection” or “for surrender” or for some other purpose not involving transfer; or

(b) the security has on it an unambiguous statement that it is the property of a person other than the transferor, but the mere writing of a name on a security is not such a statement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 70 (1).

Idem

(2) Even if a purchaser, including a broker for a seller or purchaser, has notice that a security is held for a third person or is registered in the name of or endorsed by a fiduciary, the purchaser has no duty to inquire into the rightfulness of the transfer and has no notice of an adverse claim, except that where a purchaser knows that the consideration is to be used for, or that the transaction is for, the personal benefit of the fiduciary or is otherwise in breach of the fiduciary’s duty, the purchaser is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 70 (2).

Idem

(3) An event that creates a right to immediate performance of the principal obligation evidenced by a security or that sets a date on or after which the security is to be presented or surrendered for redemption or exchange is not of itself notice of an adverse claim, except in the case of a purchase,

(a) after one year from any date set for such presentation or surrender for redemption or exchange; or

(b) after six months from any date for payment of money against presentation or surrender of the security if funds are available for payment on that date.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 70 (3).

Warranties

Warranties on presentment

71. (1) A person who presents a security for registration of transfer or for payment or exchange warrants to the issuer that the person is entitled to the registration, payment or exchange, except that a good faith purchaser who receives a new, reissued or reregistered security on registration of transfer warrants only that the purchaser has no knowledge of any unauthorized signature in a necessary endorsement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 71 (1).

Warranties on transfer

(2) A person by transferring a security to a purchaser for value warrants only that,

(a) the transfer is effective and rightful;

(b) the security is genuine and has not been materially altered; and

(c) the person knows of nothing that might impair the validity of the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 71 (2).

Warranties by intermediary

(3) Where a security is delivered by an intermediary known by the purchaser to be entrusted with delivery of the security on behalf of another or with collection of a draft or other claim to be collected against such delivery, the intermediary by such delivery warrants only the intermediary’s own good faith and authority even if the intermediary has purchased or made advances against the draft or other claim to be collected against the delivery.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 71 (3).

Warranties of pledgee

(4) A pledgee or other holder for purposes of security who redelivers a security received, or after payment and on order of the debtor delivers that security to a third person, gives only the warranties of an intermediary under subsection (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 71 (4).

Warranties of broker

(5) A broker gives to a customer, to the issuer or to a purchaser, as the case may be, the warranties provided in this section and has the rights and privileges of a purchaser under this section, and those warranties of and in favour of the broker acting as an agent are in addition to warranties given by the customer and warranties given in favour of the customer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 71 (5).

Absence of endorsement

72. Where a security in registered form has been delivered to a purchaser without a necessary endorsement, the purchaser may become a good faith purchaser only as of the time the endorsement is supplied, but against the transferor the transfer is complete upon delivery and the purchaser has a specifically enforceable right to have any necessary endorsement supplied.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 72.

Endorsement

73. (1) An endorsement of a security in registered form is made when an appropriate person signs on the security or on a separate document an assignment or transfer of the security or a power to assign or transfer it or when the signature of the person is written without more upon the back of the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 73 (1).

Idem

(2) An endorsement of a security may be,

(a) in blank, including to bearer; or

(b) a special endorsement, specifying the person to whom the security is to be transferred or who has the power to transfer it,

and a holder may convert an endorsement in blank into a special endorsement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 73 (2).

Obligation of endorser

(3) Unless otherwise agreed, the endorser by making an endorsement assumes no obligation that the security will be honoured by the issuer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 73 (3).

Partial endorsement

(4) An endorsement purporting to be only of part of a security representing units intended by the issuer to be separately transferable is effective to the extent of the endorsement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 73 (4).

Appropriate person

(5) Whether the person who has made an endorsement is appropriate shall be determined as of the date the endorsement was made and an endorsement by such person does not become unauthorized for the purposes of this Act by virtue of any subsequent change of circumstances.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 73 (5).

Improper endorsement by fiduciary

(6) Failure of a fiduciary to comply with a controlling instrument or with the law applicable to the fiduciary relationship, including any law requiring the fiduciary to obtain court approval of the transfer, does not render the fiduciary’s endorsement unauthorized for the purposes of this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 73 (6).

Delivery necessary

74. An endorsement of a security whether special or in blank does not constitute a transfer until delivery of the security on which it appears, or if the endorsement is on a separate document until the delivery of both the document and the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 74.

Endorsement of security in bearer form

75. An endorsement of a security in bearer form may give notice of an adverse claim under section 70 but does not otherwise affect any right to registration that the holder has.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 75.

Effect of unauthorized endorsement

76. (1) The owner of a security may assert the ineffectiveness of an endorsement against the issuer or any purchaser, other than a good faith purchaser who received a new, reissued or reregistered security on registration of transfer, unless the owner,

(a) has ratified an unauthorized endorsement of the security; or

(b) is otherwise precluded from impugning the effectiveness of an unauthorized endorsement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 76 (1).

Idem

(2) An issuer who registers the transfer of a security upon an unauthorized endorsement is liable for improper registration.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 76 (2).

Guarantee of signature

77. (1) Every person who guarantees a signature of an endorser of a security warrants that at the time of signing,

(a) the signature was genuine;

(b) the signer was an appropriate person to endorse; and

(c) the signer had legal capacity to sign,

but the guarantor does not otherwise warrant the rightfulness of the particular transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 77 (1).

Guarantee of endorsement

(2) Any person may guarantee an endorsement of a security and by so doing warrants not only the signature but also the rightfulness of the particular transfer in all respects.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 77 (2).

Idem

(3) No issuer may require a guarantee of endorsement as a condition to registration of transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 77 (3).

Liability of guarantor

(4) The warranties referred to in this section are made to any person taking or dealing with the security in reliance on the guarantee and the guarantor is liable to such person for any loss resulting from breach of warranty.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 77 (4).

Delivery of a security

78. (1) Delivery of a security to a purchaser occurs when,

(a) the purchaser or a person designated by the purchaser acquires possession of a security certificate;

(b) the purchaser’s broker acquires possession of a security certificate specially endorsed or issued in the name of the purchaser;

(c) the purchaser’s broker sends the purchaser confirmation of the purchase and the broker in the broker’s records identifies a specific security certificate in the broker’s possession as belonging to the purchaser;

(d) with respect to an identified security to be delivered while still in the possession of a third person, that person acknowledges that it is being held for the purchaser;

(e) an uncertificated security is registered or recorded in the name of the purchaser in records maintained by or on behalf of the issuer;

(f) with respect to a security shown in the records of a clearing agency, if the purchaser is a participant in the clearing agency, an appropriate entry in the records of the clearing agency is made under section 85; or

(g) with respect to a security shown in the records of the clearing agency, if the purchaser’s broker is a participant in the clearing agency,

(i) an appropriate entry in the records of the clearing agency is made under section 85,

(ii) the broker in the broker’s records identifies a specific security in the broker’s possession as belonging to the purchaser, and

(iii) a security interest described in subsection 85 (1.1) is no longer attached to the security.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (7).

What constitutes ownership

(2) A purchaser is the owner of a security held for the purchaser by a broker, but is not the holder except as specified in clauses (1) (b), (c) and (e).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 78 (2).

Idem

(3) If a security is part of a fungible bulk, the purchaser is the owner of a proportionate property interest in the fungible bulk.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 78 (3).

Notice of adverse claim after delivery

(4) Notice of an adverse claim received by a broker or by a purchaser after the broker takes delivery as a holder for value is not effective against the broker or the purchaser except that as between the broker and the purchaser, the purchaser may demand delivery of an equivalent security as to which no notice of an adverse claim has been received.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 78 (4).

Duty of seller to deliver

79. (1) Unless otherwise agreed where a sale of a security is made on a stock exchange recognized for the purposes of this Part by the Commission or otherwise through brokers,

(a) the selling customer fulfils the duty to deliver by placing such a security in the possession of the selling broker or of a person designated by the broker or, if requested, causes an acknowledgement to be made to the selling broker that the security is held for the selling broker; and

(b) the selling broker including a correspondent broker acting for a selling customer fulfils the duty to deliver by placing the security or a like security in the possession of the buying broker or a person designated by the buying broker or by effecting clearance of the sale in accordance with the rules of the recognized stock exchange on which the transaction took place.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 79 (1).

Idem

(2) Except as otherwise provided in this section and unless otherwise agreed, a transferor’s duty to deliver a security under a contract of purchase is not fulfilled until the transferor places the security in form to be negotiated by the purchaser in the possession of the purchaser or of a person designated by the purchaser or at the purchaser’s request causes an acknowledgement to be made to the purchaser that it is held for the purchaser.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 79 (2).

Idem

(3) A sale to a broker purchasing for the broker’s own account is subject to subsection (2) and not subsection (1), unless the sale is made on a recognized stock exchange.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 79 (3).

Action for wrongful transfer

80. (1) A person against whom the transfer of a security is wrongful for any reason, including the person’s incapacity, may against anyone except a good faith purchaser reclaim possession of the security or obtain possession of any new security evidencing all or part of the same rights or claim damages.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 80 (1).

Idem

(2) If the transfer of a security is wrongful by reason of an unauthorized endorsement, the owner may reclaim possession of the security or a replacing security even from a good faith purchaser if the ineffectiveness of the purported endorsement may be asserted against such purchaser under section 76.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 80 (2).

Specific performance and injunction

(3) The right to reclaim possession of a security may be specifically enforced, its transfer may be restrained and the security may be impounded pending litigation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 80 (3).

Transferor’s duty to provide requisites for registration of transfer

81. (1) Unless otherwise agreed, a transferor shall on demand supply a purchaser with proof of the transferor’s authority to transfer or with any other requisite that is necessary to obtain registration of the transfer of a security, but if the transfer is not for value a transferor need not do so unless the purchaser pays the reasonable and necessary costs of the proof and transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 81 (1).

Effect of failure

(2) If the transferor fails to comply with a demand under subsection (1) within a reasonable time, the purchaser may reject or rescind the transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 81 (2).

When seizure effective

82. No seizure of a security or other interest evidenced thereby is effective until the person making the seizure obtains possession of the security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 82.

Transfer by agent in good faith not conversion

83. An agent or bailee who in good faith, including observance of reasonable commercial standards if the agent or bailee is in the business of buying, selling or otherwise dealing with securities, has received securities and sold, pledged or delivered them according to the instructions of his, her or its principal is not liable for conversion or for participation in breach of fiduciary duty although the principal has no right to dispose of them.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 83.

Contract for sale

84. A contract for the sale of securities is not enforceable by way of action or defence unless,

(a) there is some writing signed by the party against whom enforcement is sought or by the party’s authorized agent or broker sufficient to indicate that a contract has been made for sale of a stated quantity of described securities at a defined or stated price;

(b) delivery of the security has been accepted or payment has been made, but the contract is enforceable under this provision only to the extent of such delivery or payment;

(c) within a reasonable time a writing in confirmation of the sale or purchase and sufficient against the sender under clause (a) has been received by the party against whom enforcement is sought and the party has failed to send written objection to its contents within a reasonable time after its receipt; or

(d) the party against whom enforcement is sought admits in the party’s pleading, testimony or otherwise in court that a contract was made for sale of a stated quantity of described securities at a defined or stated price.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 84.

Transfer through clearing agency

85. (1) If a security shown in the records of a clearing agency is evidenced by,

(a) a security certificate in the custody of the clearing agency or a custodian or of a nominee of either, subject to the instructions of the clearing agency, and is in bearer form or endorsed in blank by an appropriate person or registered in the name of the clearing agency or a custodian or of a nominee of either; or

(b) an uncertificated security registered or recorded in records maintained by or on behalf of the issuer in the name of the clearing agency or a custodian or of a nominee of either, subject to the instructions of the clearing agency,

then, in addition to other methods, a transfer or pledge of the security or any interest therein may be effected by the making of an appropriate entry in the records of the clearing agency.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 85 (1).

Priority

(1.1) If the contract governing participation in a clearing agency includes provisions that constitute a security agreement creating a security interest in securities transferred or pledged to a participant in accordance with subsection (1) and that security interest is perfected, the security interest in the securities shall, regardless of the order of perfection, have priority over any interest, including a security interest of,

(a) the participant;

(b) a purchaser whose broker is the participant; or

(c) any other person claiming from or under the participant.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (8).

Interest in fungible bulk

(2) Under this section, entries may be in respect of like securities or interests therein as part of a fungible bulk and may refer merely to a quantity of a particular security without reference to the name of the registered owner, certificate or bond number or the like and, in appropriate cases, may be on a net basis taking into account other transfers or pledges of the same security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 85 (2).

Constructive endorsement and delivery

(3) A transfer or pledge under this section has the effect of a delivery of a security in bearer form or duly endorsed in blank representing the amount of the obligation or the number of shares or rights transferred or pledged.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 85 (3).

Idem

(4) If a pledge or the creation of a security interest is intended, the making of entries has the effect of a taking of delivery by the pledgee or a secured party and the pledgee or secured party shall be deemed to have taken possession for all purposes including the purposes of the Personal Property Security Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 85 (4).

Possession

(5) A participant depositing a security certificate or an uncertificated security with a clearing agency, or a participant which is a transferee or pledgee of a security under this section, shall be deemed to have possession of the security so deposited, transferred or pledged, as the case may be, for all purposes, including, if a pledge or the creation of a security interest is intended, for the purposes of the Personal Property Security Act.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (9).

Not registration

(6) A transfer or pledge under this section does not constitute a registration of transfer under sections 86 to 90.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 85 (6).

Error in records

(7) The fact that entries in the records of the clearing agency as provided in subsection (1) are not appropriate does not affect the validity or effect of the entries nor the liabilities or obligations of the clearing agency to persons adversely affected thereby.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (9).

Conflict with other Acts

(7.1) If there is conflict between subsection (1.1) and another provision of this Act or the Personal Property Security Act, subsection (1.1) prevails.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (9).

Definitions

(8) In this section,

“issuer” includes a person, other than an individual, and a government or agency thereof,

(a) that is required by this Act to maintain a securities register,

(b) that directly or indirectly creates fractional interests in its rights or property and issues security certificates or uncertificated securities as evidence of the fractional interests,

(c) that places or authorizes the placing of its name on a security certificate, otherwise than as an authenticating trustee, registrar or transfer agent, or that otherwise authorizes the issue of a security certificate or an uncertificated security evidencing a share, participation or other interest in its property or in an enterprise or evidencing its duty to perform an obligation, or

(d) that becomes responsible for or in place of any other person described as an issuer in this section; (“émetteur”)

“participant” means a person for whom the clearing agency maintains an account in which entries may be made to effect a transfer or pledge of a security; (“membre”)

“security”, “security certificate” and “uncertificated security”, in addition to the meaning each has for the purposes of this Part, are extended to include a security, security certificate or uncertificated security, as the case may be, of an issuer within the meaning of this section. (“valeur mobilière”, “certificat de valeur mobilière”, “valeur mobilière non constatée par un certificat”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 85 (8); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (10).

Duty of issuer to register transfer

86. (1) Where a security in registered form is presented for transfer, the issuer shall register the transfer if,

(a) the security is endorsed by the appropriate person;

(b) reasonable assurance is given that that endorsement is genuine and effective;

(c) the issuer has no duty to inquire into adverse claims or has discharged any such duty;

(d) any applicable law of Canada or a province of Canada relating to the collection of taxes has been complied with;

(e) the transfer is rightful or is to a good faith purchaser; and

(f) any fee referred to in subsection 54 (2) has been paid.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 86 (1).

Liability for undue delay

(2) Where an issuer has a duty to register a transfer of a security, the issuer is liable to the person presenting it for registration or the person’s principal for loss resulting from any unreasonable delay in registration or from failure or refusal to register the transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 86 (2).

Assurances required by issuer

87. (1) For the purpose of obtaining reasonable assurance that each necessary endorsement required by section 73 is genuine and effective, the issuer may require a guarantee of the signature of the person endorsing or, where such guarantee is lacking,

(a) if the endorsement is by an agent, reasonable assurance of authority to sign;

(b) if the endorsement is by a fiduciary or a successor on whom title or control vests on the death of the holder, appropriate evidence of appointment or incumbency;

(c) if there is more than one fiduciary or successor, reasonable assurance that all who are required to sign have done so; and

(d) if the endorsement is by a person other than by a person mentioned in this section, assurance appropriate to the case equivalent as nearly as may be to those required by this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 87 (1).

Sufficiency of guarantee

(2) A “guarantee of the signature” in subsection (1) means a guarantee signed by or on behalf of a person reasonably believed by the issuer to be responsible, and the issuer may adopt reasonable standards with respect to responsibility.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 87 (2).

Appropriate evidence of appointment or incumbency

(3) For the purposes of subsection (1),

“appropriate evidence of appointment or incumbency” means,

(a) in the case of a fiduciary appointed by a court, a copy, certified in accordance with subsection 67 (7) not more than sixty days before the date the security is presented for transfer, of the order of the court,

(b) in the case of an estate of the deceased holder of net value less than $3,000 or if the market value of the securities is less than $600, proof thereof to the reasonable satisfaction of the issuer, or

(c) in any other case, a copy of a document showing the appointment or other evidence believed by the issuer to be appropriate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 87 (3).

Where contents not notice

(4) An issuer is not deemed to have notice of the contents of any document obtained under subsection (3) except to the extent that the contents relate directly to appointment or incumbency.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 87 (4).

Notice of additional assurances

(5) If an issuer demands assurance additional to that specified in this section for a purpose other than that specified in subsection (3) and obtains a copy of a will, trust or partnership agreement, by-law or similar document, the issuer shall be deemed to have notice of all matters contained therein affecting the transfer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 87 (5).

Notice to issuer of adverse claim

88. (1) An issuer to whom a security is presented for registration has a duty to inquire into adverse claims if,

(a) written notice of an adverse claim is received at a time and in a manner that affords the issuer a reasonable opportunity to act on it before the issue of a new, reissued or reregistered security and the notice discloses the name and address of the claimant, the registered owner and the issue of which the security is a part;

(b) the issuer is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim from a document that is obtained under subsection 87 (5); or

(c) the issuer is given written notice by the registered owner that the security is lost, apparently destroyed or wrongfully taken.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 88 (1).

Discharge of duty of inquiry

(2) An issuer may discharge a duty of inquiry by any reasonable means, including notifying an adverse claimant by registered mail sent to the address furnished by the adverse claimant or, if no such address has been furnished, to the adverse claimant’s residence or regular place of business, that a security has been presented for registration of transfer by a named person, and that the transfer will be registered unless within thirty days from the date of mailing the notice either,

(a) the issuer is served with a restraining order or other order of a court; or

(b) the issuer is provided with an indemnity bond sufficient in the issuer’s judgment to protect the issuer and any registrar, transfer agent or other agent of the issuer from any loss that may be incurred by any of them as a result of complying with the adverse claim.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 88 (2).

Where no duty to inquire

(3) Unless an issuer is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim from a document that is obtained under subsection 87 (5) or has received notice of an adverse claim under subsection (1), if a security presented for registration is endorsed by the appropriate person, the issuer has no duty to inquire into adverse claims and in particular,

(a) an issuer registering a security in the name of a person who is a fiduciary or who is described as a fiduciary is not bound to inquire into the existence, extent or correct description of the fiduciary relationship and thereafter the issuer may assume without inquiry that the newly registered owner continues to be the fiduciary until the issuer receives written notice that the fiduciary is no longer acting as such with respect to the particular security;

(b) an issuer registering transfer on an endorsement by a fiduciary has no duty to inquire whether the transfer is made in compliance with the document or with the law of the jurisdiction governing the fiduciary relationship; and

(c) an issuer is deemed not to have notice of the contents of any court record or any registered document even if the record or document is in the issuer’s possession and even if the transfer is made on the endorsement of a fiduciary to that fiduciary or to that fiduciary’s nominee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 88 (3).

Limitation for notice

(4) A written notice of adverse claim received by an issuer is effective for twelve months from the date when it was received unless the notice is renewed in writing.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 88 (4).

Liability of issuer

89. (1) Except as otherwise provided in any applicable law of Canada or any province of Canada relating to the collection of taxes, the issuer is not liable to the owner or any other person who incurs a loss as a result of the registration of a transfer of a security if,

(a) the necessary endorsements were on or with the security; and

(b) the issuer had no duty to inquire into adverse claims or had discharged any such duty.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 89 (1).

Idem

(2) If an issuer has registered a transfer of a security to a person not entitled to it, the issuer shall deliver on demand a like security to the owner unless,

(a) subsection (1) applies;

(b) the owner is precluded by subsection 90 (1) from asserting any claim; or

(c) the delivery would result in overissue, in which case the issuer’s liability is governed by section 58.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 89 (2).

Loss, etc., of securities

90. (1) Where a security has been lost, apparently destroyed or wrongfully taken, and the owner fails to notify the issuer of that fact by giving the issuer written notice of the owner’s adverse claim within a reasonable time after the owner knows of the loss, destruction or taking and if the issuer has registered a transfer of the security before receiving such notice, the owner is precluded from asserting against the issuer any claim to a new security.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 90 (1).

Replacing loss, etc., of securities

(2) Where the owner of a security claims that the security has been lost, apparently destroyed or wrongfully taken, the issuer shall issue a new security in place of the original security if the owner,

(a) so requests before the issuer has notice that the security has been acquired by a good faith purchaser;

(b) files with the issuer an indemnity bond sufficient in the issuer’s opinion to protect the issuer and any transfer agent, registrar or other agent of the issuer from any loss that it or any of them may suffer by complying with the request to issue a new security; and

(c) satisfies any other reasonable requirements imposed by the issuer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 90 (2).

Rights of good faith purchaser

(3) If, after the issue of a new security under subsection (2), a good faith purchaser of the original security presents the original security for registration of transfer, the issuer shall register the transfer unless registration would result in overissue, in which case the issuer’s liability is governed by section 58.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 90 (3).

Rights of issuer

(4) In addition to any rights on an indemnity bond, the issuer may recover a new security issued under subsection (2) from the person to whom it was issued or any person taking under that person other than a good faith purchaser.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 90 (4).

Duty of agents for issuer

91. (1) An authenticating trustee, transfer agent, registrar or other agent for an issuer has in respect of the issue, registration of transfer, and cancellation of a security of the issuer,

(a) a duty to the issuer and to the holder or owner to exercise good faith and due diligence; and

(b) the same obligations to the holder or owner of a security and the same rights, privileges and immunities as the issuer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 91 (1).

Notice to agents for issuer

(2) Notice to an authenticating trustee, transfer agent, registrar or other such agent is notice to the issuer with respect to the functions performed by the agent.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 91 (2).

PART VII
SHAREHOLDERS

Shareholders’ liability limited

92. (1) The shareholders of a corporation are not, as shareholders, liable for any act, default, obligation or liability of the corporation except under subsection 34 (5), subsection 108 (5) and section 243.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 92 (1).

Shares subject to call

(2) The provisions of the Corporations Act relating to the liability of a holder of shares that are not fully paid and to the enforcement of such liability apply in respect of shares that were not fully paid,

(a) on the 1st day of January, 1971, in the case of shares of a corporation that then became subject to The Business Corporations Act, being chapter 53 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1970; or

(b) on the day upon which any other body corporate was continued under The Business Corporations Act, being chapter 53 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1970, or under this Act, in the case of shares of such other body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 92 (2).

Place of meetings

93. (1) Subject to the articles and any unanimous shareholder agreement, a meeting of shareholders of a corporation shall be held at such place in or outside Ontario as the directors determine or, in the absence of such a determination, at the place where the registered office of the corporation is located.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 93.

Meeting by electronic means

(2) A meeting held under subsection 94 (2) shall be deemed to be held at the place where the registered office of the corporation is located.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 4.

Shareholders’ meetings

94. (1) Subject to subsection 104 (1), the directors of a corporation,

(a) shall call an annual meeting of shareholders not later than eighteen months after the corporation comes into existence and subsequently not later than fifteen months after holding the last preceding annual meeting; and

(b) may at any time call a special meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 94.

Meeting by electronic means

(2) Unless the articles or the by-laws provide otherwise, a meeting of the shareholders may be held by telephonic or electronic means and a shareholder who, through those means, votes at the meeting or establishes a communications link to the meeting shall be deemed for the purposes of this Act to be present at the meeting.  2001, c. 9, Sched. D, s. 2 (3).

Date for determining shareholders

95. (1) For the purpose of determining shareholders,

(a) entitled to receive payment of a dividend;

(b) entitled to participate in a liquidation or distribution; or

(c) for any other purpose except the right to receive notice of or to vote at a meeting,

the directors may fix in advance a date as the record date for such determination of shareholders, but the record date shall not precede by more than fifty days the particular action to be taken.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 95 (1).

Idem

(2) For the purpose of determining shareholders entitled to receive notice of a meeting of shareholders, the directors may fix in advance a date as the record date for such determination of shareholders, but the record date shall not precede by more than fifty days or by less than twenty-one days the date on which the meeting is to be held.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 95 (2).

Idem

(3) Where no record date is fixed,

(a) the record date for the determination of shareholders entitled to receive notice of a meeting of shareholders shall be,

(i) at the close of business on the day immediately preceding the day on which the notice is given, or

(ii) if no notice is given, the day on which the meeting is held; and

(b) the record date for the determination of shareholders for any purpose other than to establish a shareholder’s right to receive notice of a meeting or to vote shall be at the close of business on the day on which the directors pass the resolution relating thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 95 (3).

Notice of date

(4) If a record date is fixed, unless notice of the record date is waived in writing by every holder of a share of the class or series affected whose name is set out in the securities register at the close of business on the day the directors fix the record date, notice thereof shall be given, not less than seven days before the date so fixed,

(a) by advertisement in a newspaper published or distributed in the place where the corporation has its registered office and in each place in Canada where it has a transfer agent or where a transfer of its shares may be recorded; and

(b) by written notice to each stock exchange in Canada on which the shares of the corporation are listed for trading.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 95 (4).

Notice of shareholders’ meetings

96. (1) Notice of the time and place of a meeting of shareholders shall be sent, in the case of an offering corporation, not less than twenty-one days and, in the case of any other corporation, not less than ten days, but, in either case, not more than fifty days, before the meeting,

(a) to each shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting;

(b) to each director; and

(c) to the auditor of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 96 (1).

Idem

(2) A notice of a meeting is not required to be sent to shareholders who were not registered on the records of the corporation or its transfer agent on the record date determined under subsection 95 (2) or (3), but failure to receive a notice does not deprive a shareholder of the right to vote at the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 96 (2).

Idem

(3) If a meeting of shareholders is adjourned for less than thirty days, it is not necessary, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, to give notice of the adjourned meeting other than by announcement at the earliest meeting that is adjourned.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 96 (3).

Idem

(4) If a meeting of shareholders is adjourned by one or more adjournments for an aggregate of thirty days or more, notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given as for an original meeting but, unless the meeting is adjourned by one or more adjournments for an aggregate of more than ninety days, section 111 does not apply.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 96 (4).

Special business

(5) All business transacted at a special meeting of shareholders and all business transacted at an annual meeting of shareholders, except consideration of the minutes of an earlier meeting, the financial statements and auditor’s report, election of directors and reappointment of the incumbent auditor, shall be deemed to be special business.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 96 (5).

Idem

(6) Notice of a meeting of shareholders at which special business is to be transacted shall state or be accompanied by a statement of,

(a) the nature of that business in sufficient detail to permit the shareholder to form a reasoned judgment thereon; and

(b) the text of any special resolution or by-law to be submitted to the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 96 (6).

Shareholders’ meeting

97. Subject to this Act or the articles or by-laws of a corporation or a unanimous shareholder agreement,

(a) all questions proposed for the consideration of the shareholders shall be determined by the majority of the votes cast and the chair presiding at the meeting shall not have a second or casting vote in case of an equality of votes;

(b) the chair presiding at a meeting of shareholders may, with the consent of the meeting and subject to such conditions as the meeting decides, adjourn the meeting from time to time and from place to place subject to subsections 96 (3) and (4); and

(c) the president or, in his or her absence, a vice-president who is a director shall preside as chair at a meeting of shareholders, but, if there is no president or such a vice-president or if at a meeting none of them is present within fifteen minutes after the time appointed for the holding of the meeting, the shareholders present shall choose a person from their number to be the chair.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 97.

Waiving notice

98. A shareholder and any other person entitled to attend a meeting of shareholders may in any manner and at any time waive notice of a meeting of shareholders, and attendance of any such person at a meeting of shareholders is a waiver of notice of the meeting, except where such person attends a meeting for the express purpose of objecting to the transaction of any business on the grounds that the meeting is not lawfully called.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 98.

Proposal

99. (1) A shareholder entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders may,

(a) submit to the corporation notice of a proposal; and

(b) discuss at the meeting any matter in respect of which the shareholder would have been entitled to submit a proposal.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (1).

Circulating proposal

(2) Where a corporation receives notice of a proposal and the corporation solicits proxies, it shall set out the proposal in the management information circular required by section 112 or attach the proposal thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (2).

Statement in support of proposal

(3) If so requested by a shareholder giving notice of a proposal, the corporation shall include in the management information circular or attach thereto a statement by the shareholder of not more than two hundred words in support of the proposal along with the name and address of the shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (3).

Proposal may include nominations

(4) A proposal may include nominations for the election of directors if the proposal is signed by one or more holders of shares representing in the aggregate not less than 5 per cent of the shares or 5 per cent of the shares of a class or series of shares of the corporation entitled to vote at the meeting to which the proposal is to be presented, but this subsection does not preclude nominations being made at a meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (4).

Where subss. (2), (3) do not apply

(5) A corporation is not required to comply with subsections (2) and (3) where,

(a) the proposal is not submitted to the corporation at least sixty days before the anniversary date of the last annual meeting, if the matter is proposed to be raised at an annual meeting, or at least sixty days before a meeting other than the annual meeting, if the matter is proposed to be raised at a meeting other than the annual meeting;

(b) it clearly appears that the proposal is submitted by the shareholder primarily for the purpose of enforcing a personal claim or redressing a personal grievance against the corporation or any of its directors, officers or security holders, or for a purpose that is not related in any significant way to the business or affairs of the corporation;

(c) the corporation, at the shareholder’s request, included a proposal in a management information circular relating to a meeting of shareholders held within two years preceding the receipt of the request, and the shareholder failed to present the proposal, in person or by proxy, at the meeting; or

(d) substantially the same proposal was submitted to shareholders in a management information circular or a dissident’s information circular relating to a meeting of shareholders held within two years preceding the receipt of the shareholder’s request and the proposal was defeated.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (5).

Where no liability

(6) No corporation or person acting on its behalf incurs any liability by reason only of circulating a proposal or statement in compliance with this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (6).

Where refusal to circulate proposal

(7) Where a corporation refuses to include a proposal in a management information circular, the corporation shall, within ten days after receiving the proposal, send notice to the shareholder submitting the proposal of its intention to omit the proposal from the management information circular and send to the shareholder a statement of the reasons for the refusal.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (7).

Idem

(8) Upon the application of a shareholder aggrieved by a corporation’s refusal under subsection (7), the court may restrain the holding of the meeting to which the proposal is sought to be presented and make any further order it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (8).

Idem

(9) The corporation or any person aggrieved by a proposal may apply to the court for an order permitting the corporation to omit the proposal from the management information circular, and the court, if it is satisfied that subsection (5) applies, may make such order as it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (9).

Idem

(10) An applicant under subsection (8) or (9) shall give the Director notice of the application and the Director is entitled to appear and be heard in person or by counsel.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (10).

Definition

(11) In this section,

“proposal” means a matter that a shareholder entitled to vote proposes to raise at a meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 99 (11).

List of shareholders

100. (1) A corporation shall prepare a list of shareholders entitled to receive notice of a meeting, arranged in alphabetical order and showing the number of shares held by each shareholder, which list shall be prepared,

(a) if a record date is fixed under subsection 95 (2), not later than ten days after such record date; or

(b) if no record date is fixed,

(i) at the close of business on the day immediately preceding the day on which notice is given, or

(ii) where no notice is given, on the day on which the meeting is held.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 100 (1).

Entitlement to vote

(2) Where a corporation fixes a record date under subsection 95 (2), a person named in the list prepared under clause (1) (a) is entitled to vote the shares shown opposite the person’s name at the meeting to which the list relates, except to the extent that,

(a) the person has transferred any shares after the record date; and

(b) the transferee of those shares,

(i) produces properly endorsed share certificates, or

(ii) otherwise establishes that the transferee owns the shares,

and demands, not later than ten days before the meeting, or such shorter period before the meeting as the by-laws of the corporation may provide, that the transferee’s name be included in the list before the meeting,

in which case the transferee is entitled to vote those shares at the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 100 (2).

Idem

(3) Where a corporation does not fix a record date under subsection 95 (2), a person named in a list prepared under clause (1) (b) is entitled to vote the shares shown opposite the person’s name at the meeting to which the list relates, except to the extent that,

(a) the person has transferred any shares after the date on which a list referred to in subclause (1) (b) (i) is prepared; and

(b) the transferee of those shares,

(i) produces properly endorsed share certificates, or

(ii) otherwise establishes that the transferee owns the shares,

and demands not later than ten days before the meeting, or such shorter period before the meeting as the by-laws of the corporation may provide, that the transferee’s name be included in the list before the meeting,

in which case the transferee is entitled to vote those shares at the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 100 (3).

Examination of list

(4) A shareholder may examine the list of shareholders,

(a) during usual business hours at the registered office of the corporation or at the place where its central securities register is maintained; and

(b) at the meeting of shareholders for which the list was prepared.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 100 (4).

Quorum

101. (1) Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, the holders of a majority of the shares entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders, whether present in person or represented by proxy, constitute a quorum.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 101 (1).

Idem

(2) If a quorum is present at the opening of a meeting of shareholders, the shareholders present may, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, proceed with the business of the meeting even if a quorum is not present throughout the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 101 (2).

Idem

(3) If a quorum is not present at the time appointed for a meeting of shareholders, or within such reasonable time thereafter as the shareholders present may determine, the shareholders present may adjourn the meeting to a fixed time and place but may not transact any other business.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 101 (3).

Where only one shareholder

(4) If a corporation has only one shareholder, or only one holder of any class or series of shares, the shareholder present in person or by proxy constitutes a meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 101 (4).

Voting rights

102. (1) Unless the articles otherwise provide, each share of a corporation entitles the holder thereof to one vote at a meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 102 (1).

Representative

(2) Where a body corporate or association is a shareholder of a corporation, the corporation shall recognize any individual authorized by a resolution of the directors or governing body of the body corporate or association to represent it at meetings of shareholders of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 102 (2).

Idem

(3) An individual authorized as set out in subsection (2) may exercise on behalf of the body corporate or association he or she represents all the powers it could exercise if it were an individual shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 102 (3).

Joint shareholders

(4) Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, where two or more persons hold shares jointly, one of those holders present at a meeting of shareholders may in the absence of the others vote the shares, but if two or more of those persons are present, in person or by proxy, they shall vote as one on the shares jointly held by them.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 102 (4).

Manner of voting

103. (1) Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, voting at a meeting of shareholders shall be by show of hands, except where a ballot is demanded by a shareholder or proxyholder entitled to vote at the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 103 (1).

Idem

(2) A shareholder or proxyholder may demand a ballot either before or after any vote by show of hands.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 103 (2).

Entry in minutes

(3) Unless a ballot is demanded, an entry in the minutes of a meeting of shareholders to the effect that the chair declared a motion to be carried is admissible in evidence as proof of the fact, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, without proof of the number or proportion of the votes recorded in favour of or against the motion.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 103 (3).

Resolution in lieu of meeting

104. (1) Except where a written statement is submitted by a director under subsection 123 (2) or where representations in writing are submitted by an auditor under subsection 149 (6),

(a) a resolution in writing signed by all the shareholders or their attorney authorized in writing entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of shareholders is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of the shareholders; and

(b) a resolution in writing dealing with all matters required by this Act to be dealt with at a meeting of shareholders, and signed by all the shareholders or their attorney authorized in writing entitled to vote at that meeting, satisfies all the requirements of this Act relating to that meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 104 (1); 2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (5, 6).

Copy of resolution kept with minutes

(2) A copy of every resolution referred to in subsection (1) shall be kept with the minutes of the meetings of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 104 (2).

Requisition for shareholders meeting

105. (1) The holders of not less than 5 per cent of the issued shares of a corporation that carry the right to vote at a meeting sought to be held may requisition the directors to call a meeting of shareholders for the purposes stated in the requisition.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 105 (1).

Idem

(2) The requisition referred to in subsection (1) shall state the business to be transacted at the meeting and shall be sent to the registered office of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 105 (2).

Duty of directors to call meeting

(3) Upon receiving the requisition referred to in subsection (1), the directors shall call a meeting of shareholders to transact the business stated in the requisition unless,

(a) a record date has been fixed under subsection 95 (2) and notice thereof has been given under subsection 95 (4);

(b) the directors have called a meeting of shareholders and have given notice thereof under section 96; or

(c) the business of the meeting as stated in the requisition includes matters described in clauses 99 (5) (b) to (d).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 105 (3).

Where requisitionist may call meeting

(4) Subject to subsection (3), if the directors do not within twenty-one days after receiving the requisition referred to in subsection (1) call a meeting, any shareholder who signed the requisition may call the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 105 (4).

Calling of meeting

(5) A meeting called under this section shall be called as nearly as possible in the manner in which meetings are to be called under the by-laws, this Part and Part VIII.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 105 (5).

Repayment of expenses

(6) The corporation shall reimburse the shareholders for the expenses reasonably incurred by them in requisitioning, calling and holding the meeting unless the shareholders have not acted in good faith and in the interest of the shareholders of the corporation generally.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 105 (6).

Requisition by court

106. (1) If for any reason it is impracticable to call a meeting of shareholders of a corporation in the manner in which meetings of those shareholders may be called or to conduct the meeting in the manner prescribed by the by-laws, the articles and this Act, or if for any other reason the court thinks fit, the court, upon the application of a director or a shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting, may order a meeting to be called, held and conducted in such manner as the court directs and upon such terms as to security for the costs of holding the meeting or otherwise as the court deems fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 106 (1).

Power of court

(2) Without restricting the generality of subsection (1), the court may order that the quorum required by the by-laws, the articles or this Act be varied or dispensed with at a meeting called, held and conducted under this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 106 (2).

Effect of meeting

(3) A meeting called, held and conducted under this section is for all purposes a meeting of shareholders of the corporation duly called, held and conducted.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 106 (3).

Determination of controversy

107. (1) A corporation, shareholder or director may apply to the court to determine any controversy with respect to an election or appointment of a director or auditor of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 107 (1).

Court order

(2) Upon an application under this section, the court may make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order restraining a director or auditor whose election or appointment is challenged from acting pending determination of the dispute;

(b) an order declaring the result of the disputed election or appointment;

(c) an order requiring a new election or appointment and including in the order directions for the management of the business and affairs of the corporation until a new election is held or appointment made; and

(d) an order determining the voting rights of shareholders and of persons claiming to own shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 107 (2).

Agreement between shareholders

108. (1) A written agreement between two or more shareholders may provide that in exercising voting rights the shares held by them shall be voted as therein provided.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 108 (1).

Idem

(2) A written agreement among all the shareholders of a corporation or among all the shareholders and one or more persons who are not shareholders may restrict in whole or in part the powers of the directors to manage or supervise the management of the business and affairs of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 108 (2).

Unanimous shareholder agreement

(3) Where a person who is the beneficial owner of all the issued shares of a corporation makes a written declaration that restricts in whole or in part the powers of the directors to manage or supervise the management of the business and affairs of a corporation, the declaration shall be deemed to be a unanimous shareholder agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 108 (3).

Party to unanimous shareholder agreement

(4) Subject to subsection 56 (3), a transferee of shares subject to a unanimous shareholder agreement shall be deemed to be a party to the agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 108 (4).

Where shareholder has power, etc., of director

(5) A shareholder who is a party to a unanimous shareholder agreement has all the rights, powers, duties and liabilities of a director of the corporation, whether arising under this Act or otherwise, to which the agreement relates to the extent that the agreement restricts the discretion or powers of the directors to manage or supervise the management of the business and affairs of the corporation and the directors are thereby relieved of their duties and liabilities, including any liabilities under section 131, to the same extent.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 108 (5).

Matter that a unanimous shareholder agreement may provide

(6) A unanimous shareholder agreement may, without restricting the generality of subsection (2), provide that,

(a) any amendment of the unanimous shareholder agreement may be effected in the manner specified therein; and

(b) in the event that shareholders who are parties to the unanimous shareholder agreement are unable to agree on or resolve any matter pertaining to the agreement, the matter may be referred to arbitration under such procedures and conditions as are specified in the unanimous shareholder agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 108 (6).

PART VIII
PROXIES

Definitions

109. In this Part,

“dissident’s information circular” means the circular referred to in clause 112 (1) (b); (“circulaire d’information d’un dissident”)

“form of proxy” means a form that is in written or printed format or a format generated by telephonic or electronic means and that becomes a proxy when completed and signed in writing or electronic signature by or on behalf of a shareholder; (“formule de procuration”)

“management information circular” means the circular referred to in clause 112 (1) (a); (“circulaire d’information de la direction”)

“proxy” means a completed and signed form of proxy by means of which a shareholder has appointed a proxyholder to attend and act on a shareholder’s behalf at a meeting of shareholders; (“procuration”)

“solicit” and “solicitation” include,

(a) a request for a proxy whether or not accompanied by or included in a form of proxy,

(b) a request to execute or not to execute a form of proxy or to revoke a proxy,

(c) the sending of a form of proxy or other communication to a shareholder under circumstances reasonably calculated to result in the procurement, withholding or revocation of a proxy, and

(d) the sending of a form of proxy to a shareholder under section 111,

but do not include,

(e) the sending of a form of proxy in response to an unsolicited request made by or on behalf of a shareholder,

(f) the performance of administrative acts or professional services on behalf of a person soliciting a proxy,

(g) the sending of material under section 49 of the Securities Act,

(h) a solicitation by a person in respect of shares of which the person is the beneficial owner; (“sollicitation”, “solliciter”)

“solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a corporation” means a solicitation by any person under a resolution or the instructions of the directors of that corporation or a committee of such directors. (“sollicitation effectuée par la direction ou pour son compte”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 109; 1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 6.

Proxies

110. (1) Every shareholder entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders may by means of a proxy appoint a proxyholder or one or more alternate proxyholders, who need not be shareholders, as the shareholder’s nominee to attend and act at the meeting in the manner, to the extent and with the authority conferred by the proxy.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 110 (1).

Signature

(2) Subject to subsection (4.2), a proxy must be signed,

(a) in writing or by electronic signature by the shareholder or an attorney who is authorized by a document that is signed in writing or by electronic signature; or

(b) if the shareholder is a body corporate, by an officer or attorney of the body corporate duly authorized.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 7 (1).

Expiry

(2.1) A proxy appointing a proxyholder to attend and act at a meeting or meetings of shareholders of an offering corporation ceases to be valid one year from its date.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 7 (1).

Form of proxy

(3) Every form of proxy shall comply with the regulations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 110 (3).

Revocation

(4) A shareholder may revoke a proxy,

(a) by depositing an instrument in writing that complies with subsection (4.1) and that is signed by the shareholder or by an attorney who is authorized by a document that is signed in writing or by electronic signature;

(b) by transmitting, by telephonic or electronic means, a revocation that complies with subsection (4.1) and that, subject to subsection (4.2), is signed by electronic signature; or

(c) in any other manner permitted by law.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 7 (2).

Time of revocation

(4.1) The instrument or the revocation must be received,

(a) at the registered office of the corporation at any time up to and including the last business day preceding the day of the meeting, or any adjournment of it, at which the proxy is to be used; or

(b) by the chair of the meeting on the day of the meeting or an adjournment of it.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 7 (2).

Electronic signature

(4.2) A shareholder or an attorney may sign, by electronic signature, a proxy, a revocation of proxy or a power of attorney authorizing the creation of either of them if the means of electronic signature permits a reliable determination that the document was created or communicated by or on behalf of the shareholder or the attorney, as the case may be.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 7 (2).

Time limit for deposit

(5) The directors may by resolution fix a time not exceeding forty-eight hours, excluding Saturdays and holidays, preceding any meeting or adjourned meeting of shareholders before which time proxies to be used at that meeting must be deposited with the corporation or an agent thereof, and any period of time so fixed shall be specified in the notice calling the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 110 (5).

Mandatory solicitation of proxy

111. The management of an offering corporation shall, concurrently with or prior to sending notice of a meeting of shareholders, send a form of proxy to each shareholder who is entitled to receive notice of the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 111.

Information circular

112. (1) No person shall solicit proxies in respect of an offering corporation unless,

(a) in the case of solicitation by or on behalf of the management of the corporation, a management information circular in prescribed form, either as an appendix to or as a separate document accompanying the notice of the meeting; or

(b) in the case of any other solicitation, a dissident’s information circular in prescribed form,

is sent to the auditor of the corporation, to each shareholder whose proxy is solicited and, if clause (b) applies, to the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 112 (1).

Filing copy

(2) A person, upon sending a management or dissident’s information circular, shall concurrently file with the Commission,

(a) in the case of a management information circular, a copy thereof together with a copy of the notice of meeting, form of proxy and of any other documents for use in connection with the meeting; and

(b) in the case of a dissident’s information circular, a copy thereof together with a copy of the form of proxy and of any other documents for use in connection with the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 112 (2).

Exemption order re ss. 111, 112

113. Upon the application of any interested person, the Commission may, if satisfied in the circumstances of the particular case that there is adequate justification for so doing, make an order, on such terms and conditions as the Commission may impose, exempting, in whole or in part, any person from the requirements of section 111 or from the requirements of section 112.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 113.

Proxyholder

114. (1) A person who solicits a proxy and is appointed proxyholder shall attend in person or cause an alternate proxyholder to attend the meeting in respect of which the proxy is given and comply with the directions of the shareholder who appointed the person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 114 (1).

Rights of proxyholder

(2) A proxyholder or an alternate proxyholder has the same rights as the shareholder who appointed him or her to speak at a meeting of shareholders in respect of any matter, to vote by way of ballot at the meeting and, except where a proxyholder or an alternate proxyholder has conflicting instructions from more than one shareholder, to vote at such a meeting in respect of any matter by way of a show of hands.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 114 (2).

Vote

(3) Despite subsections (1) and (2), where the chair of a meeting of shareholders declares to the meeting that, to the best of his or her belief, if a ballot is conducted, the total number of votes attached to the shares represented at the meeting by proxy required to be voted against what will be the decision of the meeting in relation to any matter or group of matters is less than 5 per cent of all the votes that might be cast at the meeting on such ballot, and where a shareholder, proxyholder or alternate proxyholder does not demand a ballot,

(a) the chair may conduct the vote in respect of that matter or group of matters by a show of hands; and

(b) a proxyholder or alternate proxyholder may vote in respect of that matter or group of matters by a show of hands.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 114 (3).

PART IX
DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

Directors

115. (1) Subject to any unanimous shareholder agreement, the directors shall manage or supervise the management of the business and affairs of a corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 115 (1).

Board of directors

(2) A corporation shall have a board of directors which shall consist of,

(a) in the case of a corporation that is not an offering corporation, at least one individual; and

(b) in the case of a corporation that is an offering corporation, not fewer than three individuals.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 115 (2); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (11).

Idem

(3) At least one-third of the directors of an offering corporation shall not be officers or employees of the corporation or any of its affiliates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 115 (3).

Deemed directors

(4) Where all of the directors have resigned or have been removed by the shareholders without replacement, any person who manages or supervises the management of the business and affairs of the corporation shall be deemed to be a director for the purposes of this Act.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (12).

Exceptions

(5) Subsection (4) does not apply to,

(a) an officer who manages the business of the corporation under the direction or control of a shareholder or other person;

(b) a lawyer, accountant or other professional who participates in the management of the corporation solely for the purposes of providing professional services; or

(c) a trustee in bankruptcy, receiver, receiver-manager or secured creditor who participates in the management of the corporation or exercises control over its property solely for the purposes of enforcement of a security agreement or administration of a bankrupt’s estate, in the case of a trustee in bankruptcy.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (12).

By-laws by resolution

116. (1) Unless the articles, the by-laws or a unanimous shareholder agreement otherwise provide, the directors may, by resolution, make, amend or repeal any by-laws that regulate the business or affairs of a corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 116 (1).

Confirmation by shareholders

(2) Where the directors make, amend or repeal a by-law under subsection (1), they shall submit the by-law, amendment or repeal to the shareholders at the next meeting of shareholders, and the shareholders may confirm, reject or amend the by-law, amendment or repeal.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 116 (2).

Effective date

(3) Where a by-law is made, amended or repealed under subsection (1), the by-law, amendment or repeal is effective from the date of the resolution of the directors until it is confirmed, confirmed as amended or rejected by the shareholders under subsection (2) or until it ceases to be effective under subsection (4) and, where the by-law is confirmed or confirmed as amended, it continues in effect in the form in which it was so confirmed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 116 (3).

Rejection, etc.

(4) If a by-law or an amendment or repeal of a by-law is rejected by the shareholders, or if the directors do not submit the by-law, amendment or repeal to the shareholders as required under subsection (2), the by-law, amendment or repeal ceases to be effective on the date of such rejection or on the date of the meeting of shareholders at which it should have been submitted, as the case may be, and no subsequent resolution of the directors to make, amend or repeal a by-law having substantially the same purpose or effect is effective until it is confirmed or confirmed as amended by the shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 116 (4); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 21.

By-law re shareholder proposal

(5) If a shareholder proposal to make, amend or repeal a by-law is made in accordance with section 99 and is adopted by shareholders at a meeting, the by-law, amendment or repeal is effective from the date of its adoption and requires no further confirmation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 116 (5).

By-law need not be so described

(6) A by-law need not be described as a by-law in a resolution referred to in this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 116 (6).

First directors meeting

117. (1) After incorporation, a meeting of the directors of a corporation shall be held at which the directors may,

(a) make by-laws;

(b) adopt forms of security certificates and corporate records;

(c) authorize the issue of securities;

(d) appoint officers;

(e) appoint one or more auditors to hold office until the first annual or special meeting of shareholders;

(f) make banking arrangements; and

(g) transact any other business.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 117 (1).

Resolution in writing

(2) Any matter referred to in subsection (1) may be dealt with by the directors by a resolution in writing in accordance with subsection 129 (1).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 117 (2).

Where subs. (1) does not apply

(3) Subsection (1) does not apply to a body corporate that is an amalgamated corporation under section 178 or that is continued under section 180.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 117 (3).

Calling meeting

(4) An incorporator or a director may call the meeting of directors referred to in subsection (1) by giving not less than five days notice thereof to each director, stating the time and place of the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 117 (4).

Qualifications of directors

118. (1) The following persons are disqualified from being a director of a corporation:

1. A person who is less than eighteen years of age.

2. A person who is of unsound mind and has been so found by a court in Canada or elsewhere.

3. A person who is not an individual.

4. A person who has the status of bankrupt.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 118 (1).

Holding shares

(2) Unless the articles otherwise provide, a director of a corporation is not required to hold shares issued by the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 118 (2).

Directors to be resident Canadians

(3) A majority of the directors of every corporation other than a non-resident corporation shall be resident Canadians but where a corporation has only one or two directors, that director or one of the two directors, as the case may be, shall be a resident Canadian.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 118 (3).

First directors

119. (1) Each director named in the articles shall hold office from the date of endorsement of the certificate of incorporation until the first meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (1).

Resignation

(2) Until the first meeting of shareholders, the resignation of a director named in the articles shall not be effective unless at the time the resignation is to become effective a successor has been elected or appointed.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (13).

Powers and duties

(3) The first directors of a corporation named in the articles have all the powers and duties and are subject to all the liabilities of directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (3).

Election of directors

(4) Subject to clause 120 (a), shareholders of a corporation shall elect, at the first meeting of shareholders and at each succeeding annual meeting at which an election of directors is required, directors to hold office for a term expiring not later than the close of the third annual meeting of shareholders following the election.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (4).

Term for directors

(5) It is not necessary that all directors elected at a meeting of shareholders hold office for the same term.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (5).

Idem

(6) A director not elected for an expressly stated term ceases to hold office at the close of the first annual meeting of shareholders following his or her election.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (6).

Idem

(7) Despite this section, if directors are not elected at a meeting of shareholders the incumbent directors continue in office until their successors are elected.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (7).

Failure to elect required number of directors

(8) If a meeting of shareholders fails to elect the number of directors required by the articles or by section 125 by reason of the disqualification, incapacity or death of one or more candidates, the directors elected at that meeting, if they constitute a quorum, may exercise all the powers of the directors of the corporation pending the holding of a meeting of shareholders in accordance with subsection 124 (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 119 (8).

Consent required

(9) Subject to subsection (10), the election or appointment of a director under this Act is not effective unless the person elected or appointed consents in writing before or within 10 days after the date of the election or appointment.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 8.

Later consent

(10) If the person elected or appointed consents in writing after the time period mentioned in subsection (9), the election or appointment is valid.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 8.

Exception

(11) Subsection (9) does not apply to a director who is re-elected or re-appointed where there is no break in the director’s term of office.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 8.

Cumulative voting for directors

120. Where the articles provide for cumulative voting,

(a) each shareholder entitled to vote at an election of directors has the right to cast a number of votes equal to the number of votes attached to the shares held by the shareholder multiplied by the number of directors to be elected, and the shareholder may cast all such votes in favour of one candidate or distribute them among the candidates in any manner;

(b) a separate vote of shareholders shall be taken with respect to each candidate nominated for director unless a resolution is passed unanimously permitting two or more persons to be elected by a single resolution;

(c) if a shareholder has voted for more than one candidate without specifying the distribution of the shareholder’s votes among the candidates, the shareholder is deemed to have distributed the shareholder’s votes equally among the candidates for whom the shareholder voted;

(d) if the number of candidates nominated for director exceeds the number of positions to be filled, the candidates who receive the least number of votes shall be eliminated until the number of candidates remaining equals the number of positions to be filled;

(e) each director ceases to hold office at the close of the first annual meeting of shareholders following his or her election;

(f) a director may not be removed from office if the votes cast against the director’s removal would be sufficient to elect him or her and such votes could be voted cumulatively at an election at which the same total number of votes were cast and the number of directors required by the articles were then being elected;

(g) the number of directors required by the articles may not be decreased if the votes cast against the motion to decrease would be sufficient to elect a director and such votes could be voted cumulatively at an election at which the same total number of votes were cast and the number of directors required by the articles were then being elected; and

(h) the articles shall require a fixed number and not a minimum and maximum number of directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 120.

When director ceases to hold office

121. (1) A director of a corporation ceases to hold office when he or she,

(a) dies or, subject to subsection 119 (2), resigns;

(b) is removed in accordance with section 122; or

(c) becomes disqualified under subsection 118 (1).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 121 (1).

Idem

(2) A resignation of a director becomes effective at the time a written resignation is received by the corporation or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 121 (2).

Removal of directors

122. (1) Subject to clause 120 (f), the shareholders of a corporation may by ordinary resolution at an annual or special meeting remove any director or directors from office.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 122 (1).

Idem

(2) Where the holders of any class or series of shares of a corporation have an exclusive right to elect one or more directors, a director so elected may only be removed by an ordinary resolution at a meeting of the shareholders of that class or series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 122 (2).

Idem

(3) Subject to clauses 120 (a) to (d), a vacancy created by the removal of a director may be filled at the meeting of the shareholders at which the director is removed or, if not so filled, may be filled under section 124.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 122 (3).

Entitlement of director

123. (1) A director of a corporation is entitled to receive notice of and to attend and be heard at every meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 123 (1).

Idem

(2) A director who,

(a) resigns;

(b) receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of shareholders called for the purpose of removing him or her from office; or

(c) receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of directors or shareholders at which another person is to be appointed or elected to fill the office of director, whether because of the resignation or removal of the director or because his or her term of office has expired or is about to expire,

is entitled to submit to the corporation a written statement giving the reasons for the director’s resignation or the reasons why he or she opposes any proposed action or resolution, as the case may be.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 123 (2).

Distribution of statement

(3) Upon receiving a statement under subsection (2), a corporation shall forthwith send a copy of the statement to every shareholder entitled to receive notice of meetings of shareholders and to the Director unless the statement is included in or attached to a management information circular required by section 112.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 123 (3).

No liability

(4) No corporation or person acting on its behalf incurs any liability by reason only of circulating a director’s statement in compliance with subsection (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 123 (4).

Vacancies

124. (1) Despite subsection 126 (6), but subject to subsections (2), (4) and (5) of this section, a quorum of directors may fill a vacancy among the directors, except a vacancy resulting from,

(a) an increase in the number of directors otherwise than in accordance with subsection (2), or in the maximum number of directors, as the case may be; or

(b) a failure to elect the number of directors required to be elected at any meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 124 (1).

Appointment of directors subsequent to annual meeting

(2) Where a special resolution passed under subsection 125 (3) empowers the directors of a corporation the articles of which provide for a minimum and maximum number of directors to determine the number of directors, the directors may not, between meetings of shareholders, appoint an additional director if, after such appointment, the total number of directors would be greater than one and one-third times the number of directors required to have been elected at the last annual meeting of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 124 (2).

Election of directors to make quorum

(3) If there is not a quorum of directors, or if there has been a failure to elect the number of directors required by the articles or by section 125, the directors then in office shall forthwith call a special meeting of shareholders to fill the vacancy and, if they fail to call a meeting or if there are no directors then in office, the meeting may be called by any shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 124 (3).

Where elected by class of shareholders

(4) Where the holders of any class or series of shares of a corporation have an exclusive right to elect one or more directors and a vacancy occurs among those directors,

(a) subject to subsection (5), the remaining directors elected by that class or series may fill the vacancy except a vacancy resulting from an increase in the number of directors for that class or series or from a failure to elect the number of directors for that class or series; or

(b) if there are no such remaining directors, any holder of shares of that class or series may call a meeting of the holders thereof for the purpose of filling the vacancy.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 124 (4).

Idem, where no quorum

(5) The articles may provide that a vacancy among the directors shall only be filled by a vote of the shareholders, or by a vote of the holders of any class or series of shares having an exclusive right to elect one or more directors if the vacancy occurs among the directors elected by that class or series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 124 (5).

Term

(6) A director appointed or elected to fill a vacancy holds office for the unexpired term of the director’s predecessor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 124 (6).

Change in number of directors

125. (1) A corporation may increase or decrease the number, or the minimum or maximum number, of its directors in accordance with clause 168 (1) (m), but no decrease in the number of directors shall shorten the term of an incumbent director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 125 (1).

Articles amendment

(2) Where a corporation has increased or decreased the number of directors by special by-law under a predecessor of this Act, the special by-law shall be deemed to constitute an amendment to its articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 125 (2).

Number of directors

(3) Where a minimum and maximum number of directors of a corporation is provided for in its articles, the number of directors of the corporation and the number of directors to be elected at the annual meeting of the shareholders shall be such number as shall be determined from time to time by special resolution or, if the special resolution empowers the directors to determine the number, by resolution of the directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 125 (3).

Idem

(4) Where no resolution has been passed under subsection (3), the number of directors of the corporation shall be the number of directors named in its articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 125 (4).

(5) Repealed:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 22 (1).

(6) Repealed:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 22 (2).

Place of meetings and quorum

126. (1) Subject to subsection (2), a meeting of the board of directors shall be held at the place where the registered office of the corporation is located.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (1).

Exceptions

(2) Where the by-laws of the corporation so provide, a meeting of the board of directors may be held at any place within or outside Ontario, but, except where the corporation is a non-resident corporation or the articles or the by-laws otherwise provide, in any financial year of the corporation a majority of the meetings of the board of directors shall be held at a place within Canada.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (2).

Quorum

(3) Subject to the articles or by-laws and subsection (4), a majority of the number of directors or minimum number of directors required by the articles constitutes a quorum at any meeting of directors, but in no case shall a quorum be less than two-fifths of the number of directors or minimum number of directors, as the case may be.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (3).

Idem

(4) Where a corporation has fewer than three directors, all directors must be present at any meeting of directors to constitute a quorum.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (4).

Idem

(5) Subject to the articles or by-laws, where there is a vacancy or vacancies in the board of directors, the remaining directors may exercise all the powers of the board so long as a quorum of the board remains in office.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (5).

Transacting business

(6) Directors, other than directors of a non-resident corporation, shall not transact business at a meeting of directors unless a majority of directors present are resident Canadians or, where a corporation has fewer than three directors, one of the directors present is a resident Canadian.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (6).

Idem

(7) Despite subsection (6), directors may transact business at a meeting of directors where a majority of resident Canadian directors is not present if,

(a) a resident Canadian director who is unable to be present approves in writing or by telephone or other communications facilities the business transacted at the meeting; and

(b) a majority of resident Canadian directors would have been present had that director been present at the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (7).

Calling meeting of directors

(8) In addition to any other provision in the articles or by-laws of a corporation for calling meetings of directors, a quorum of the directors may, at any time, call a meeting of the directors for the transaction of any business the general nature of which is specified in the notice calling the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (8).

Notice

(9) In the absence of any other provision in that behalf in the by-laws of the corporation, notice of the time and place for the holding of the meeting called under subsection (8) shall be given to every director of the corporation by sending the notice ten days or more before the date of the meeting to each director’s latest address as shown on the records of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (9).

Waiver of notice

(10) A director may in any manner and at any time waive a notice of a meeting of directors and attendance of a director at a meeting of directors is a waiver of notice of the meeting, except where a director attends a meeting for the express purpose of objecting to the transaction of any business on the grounds that the meeting is not lawfully called.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (10).

Adjourned meeting

(11) Notice of an adjourned meeting of directors is not required to be given if the time and place of the adjourned meeting is announced at the original meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (11).

Where one director

(12) Where a corporation has only one director, that director may constitute a meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (12).

Meeting by telephone, etc.

(13) Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, if all the directors of a corporation present at or participating in the meeting consent, a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors may be held by means of such telephone, electronic or other communication facilities as permit all persons participating in the meeting to communicate with each other simultaneously and instantaneously, and a director participating in such a meeting by such means is deemed for the purposes of this Act to be present at that meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (13).

Place of meeting by telephone

(14) If a majority of the directors participating in a meeting held under subsection (13) are then in Canada, the meeting shall be deemed to have been held in Canada.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 126 (14).

Delegation by directors

127. (1) Subject to the articles or by-laws, directors of a corporation may appoint from their number a managing director, who is a resident Canadian, or a committee of directors and delegate to such managing director or committee any of the powers of the directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 127 (1).

Idem

(2) If the directors of a corporation other than a non-resident corporation, appoint a committee of directors, a majority of the members of the committee shall be resident Canadians.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 127 (2).

Limitations on authority

(3) Despite subsection (1), no managing director and no committee of directors has authority to,

(a) submit to the shareholders any question or matter requiring the approval of the shareholders;

(b) fill a vacancy among the directors or in the office of auditor or appoint or remove any of the chief executive officers, however designated, the chief financial officer, however designated, the chair or the president of the corporation;

(c) subject to section 184, issue securities except in the manner and on the terms authorized by the directors;

(d) declare dividends;

(e) purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire shares issued by the corporation;

(f) pay a commission referred to in section 37;

(g) approve a management information circular referred to in Part VIII;

(h) approve a take-over bid circular, directors’ circular or issuer bid circular referred to in Part XX of the Securities Act;

(i) approve any financial statements referred to in clause 154 (1) (b) of the Act and Part XVIII of the Securities Act;

(i.1) approve an amalgamation under section 177 or an amendment to the articles under subsection 168 (2) or (4); or

(j) adopt, amend or repeal by-laws.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 127 (3); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (16).

Validity of acts of directors and officers

128. An act done by a director or by an officer is not invalid by reason only of any defect that is thereafter discovered in his or her appointment, election or qualification.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 128.

Resolutions in writing

129. (1) A resolution in writing, signed by all the directors entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of directors or a committee of directors, is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of directors or a committee of directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 129 (1).

Copy to be kept

(2) A copy of every resolution passed under subsection (1) shall be kept with the minutes of the proceedings of the directors or committee of directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 129 (2).

Liability of directors

130. (1) Directors of a corporation who vote for or consent to a resolution authorizing the issue of a share for a consideration other than money contrary to section 23 are jointly and severally liable to the corporation to make good any amount by which the consideration received is less than the fair equivalent of the money that the corporation would have received if the share had been issued for money on the date of the resolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 130 (1).

Idem

(2) Directors of a corporation who vote for or consent to a resolution authorizing,

(a) any financial assistance contrary to section 20;

(b) a purchase, redemption or other acquisition of shares contrary to section 30, 31 or 32;

(c) a commission contrary to section 37;

(d) a payment of a dividend contrary to section 38;

(e) a payment of an indemnity contrary to section 136; or

(f) a payment to a shareholder contrary to section 185 or 248,

are jointly and severally liable to restore to the corporation any amounts so distributed or paid and not otherwise recovered by the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 130 (2).

Joint liability

(3) A director who has satisfied a judgment rendered under this section is entitled to contribution from the other directors who voted for or consented to the unlawful act upon which the judgment was founded.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 130 (3).

Application to court

(4) A director liable under subsection (2) is entitled to apply to the court for an order compelling a shareholder or other recipient to pay or deliver to the director any money or property that was paid or distributed to the shareholder or other recipient contrary to section 20, 30, 31, 32, 37, 38, 136, 185 or 248.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 130 (4).

What court may order

(5) In connection with an application under subsection (4), the court may, if it is satisfied that it is equitable to do so,

(a) order a shareholder or other recipient to pay or deliver to a director any money or property that was paid or distributed to the shareholder or other recipient contrary to section 20, 30, 31, 32, 37, 38, 136, 185 or 248;

(b) order a corporation to return or issue shares to a person from whom the corporation has purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired shares; or

(c) make any further order it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 130 (5).

Exception to subs. (1)

(6) A director is not liable under subsection (1) if the director proves that he or she did not know and could not reasonably have known that the share was issued for a consideration less than the fair equivalent of the money that the corporation would have received if the share had been issued for money.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 130 (6).

(7) Repealed:  2002, c. 24, Sched. B, s. 25.

Directors’ liability to employees for wages

131. (1) The directors of a corporation are jointly and severally liable to the employees of the corporation for all debts not exceeding six months’ wages that become payable while they are directors for services performed for the corporation and for the vacation pay accrued while they are directors for not more than twelve months under the Employment Standards Act, and the regulations thereunder, or under any collective agreement made by the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 131 (1).

Limitation of liability

(2) A director is liable under subsection (1) only if,

(a) the corporation is sued in the action against the director and execution against the corporation is returned unsatisfied in whole or in part; or

(b) before or after the action is commenced, the corporation goes into liquidation, is ordered to be wound up or makes an authorized assignment under the Bankruptcy and Insolvency Act (Canada), or a receiving order under that Act is made against it, and, in any such case, the claim for the debt has been proved.  2002, c. 24, Sched. B, s. 27 (1).

Idem

(3) Where execution referred to in clause (2) (b) has issued, the amount recoverable from a director is the amount remaining unsatisfied after execution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 131 (3).

Rights of director who pays debt

(4) Where a director pays a debt under subsection (1) that is proved in liquidation and dissolution or bankruptcy proceedings, the director is entitled to any preference that the employee would have been entitled to, and where a judgment has been obtained the director is entitled to an assignment of the judgment.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 131 (4).

Idem

(5) A director who has satisfied a claim under this section is entitled to contribution from the other directors who were liable for the claim.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 131 (5).

Disclosure: conflict of interest

132. (1) A director or officer of a corporation who,

(a) is a party to a material contract or transaction or proposed material contract or transaction with the corporation; or

(b) is a director or an officer of, or has a material interest in, any person who is a party to a material contract or transaction or proposed material contract or transaction with the corporation,

shall disclose in writing to the corporation or request to have entered in the minutes of meetings of directors the nature and extent of his or her interest.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (1).

by director

(2) The disclosure required by subsection (1) shall be made, in the case of a director,

(a) at the meeting at which a proposed contract or transaction is first considered;

(b) if the director was not then interested in a proposed contract or transaction, at the first meeting after he or she becomes so interested;

(c) if the director becomes interested after a contract is made or a transaction is entered into, at the first meeting after he or she becomes so interested; or

(d) if a person who is interested in a contract or transaction later becomes a director, at the first meeting after he or she becomes a director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (2).

by officer

(3) The disclosure required by subsection (1) shall be made, in the case of an officer who is not a director,

(a) forthwith after the officer becomes aware that the contract or transaction or proposed contract or transaction is to be considered or has been considered at a meeting of directors;

(b) if the officer becomes interested after a contract is made or a transaction is entered into, forthwith after he or she becomes so interested; or

(c) if a person who is interested in a contract or transaction later becomes an officer, forthwith after he or she becomes an officer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (3).

Where contract or transaction does not require approval

(4) Despite subsections (2) and (3), where subsection (1) applies to a director or officer in respect of a material contract or transaction or proposed material contract or transaction that, in the ordinary course of the corporation’s business, would not require approval by the directors or shareholders, the director or officer shall disclose in writing to the corporation or request to have entered in the minutes of meetings of directors the nature and extent of his or her interest forthwith after the director or officer becomes aware of the contract or transaction or proposed contract or transaction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (4).

Director not to vote

(5) A director referred to in subsection (1) shall not vote on any resolution to approve the contract or transaction unless the contract or transaction is,

(a) an arrangement by way of security for money lent to or obligations undertaken by the director for the benefit of the corporation or an affiliate;

(b) one relating primarily to his or her remuneration as a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation or an affiliate;

(c) one for indemnity or insurance under section 136; or

(d) one with an affiliate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (5).

General notice of interest

(6) For the purposes of this section, a general notice to the directors by a director or officer disclosing that he or she is a director or officer of or has a material interest in a person and is to be regarded as interested in any contract made or any transaction entered into with that person, is a sufficient disclosure of interest in relation to any contract so made or transaction so entered into.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (6).

Effect of disclosure

(7) Where a material contract is made or a material transaction is entered into between a corporation and a director or officer of the corporation, or between a corporation and another person of which a director or officer of the corporation is a director or officer or in which he or she has a material interest,

(a) the director or officer is not accountable to the corporation or its shareholders for any profit or gain realized from the contract or transaction; and

(b) the contract or transaction is neither void nor voidable,

by reason only of that relationship or by reason only that the director is present at or is counted to determine the presence of a quorum at the meeting of directors that authorized the contract or transaction, if the director or officer disclosed his or her interest in accordance with subsection (2), (3), (4) or (6), as the case may be, and the contract or transaction was reasonable and fair to the corporation at the time it was so approved.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (7).

Confirmation by shareholders

(8) Despite anything in this section, a director or officer, acting honestly and in good faith, is not accountable to the corporation or to its shareholders for any profit or gain realized from any such contract or transaction by reason only of his or her holding the office of director or officer, and the contract or transaction, if it was reasonable and fair to the corporation at the time it was approved, is not by reason only of the director’s or officer’s interest therein void or voidable, where,

(a) the contract or transaction is confirmed or approved by special resolution at a meeting of the shareholders duly called for that purpose; and

(b) the nature and extent of the director’s or officer’s interest in the contract or transaction are disclosed in reasonable detail in the notice calling the meeting or in the information circular required by section 112.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (8).

Court setting aside contract

(9) Subject to subsections (7) and (8), where a director or officer of a corporation fails to disclose his or her interest in a material contract or transaction in accordance with this section or otherwise fails to comply with this section, the corporation or a shareholder of the corporation, or, in the case of an offering corporation, the Commission may apply to the court for an order setting aside the contract or transaction and directing that the director or officer account to the corporation for any profit or gain realized and upon such application the court may so order or make such other order as it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 132 (9).

Officers

133. Subject to the articles, the by-laws or any unanimous shareholder agreement,

(a) the directors may designate the offices of the corporation, appoint officers, specify their duties and delegate to them powers to manage the business and affairs of the corporation, except, subject to section 184, powers to do anything referred to in subsection 127 (3);

(b) a director may be appointed to any office of the corporation; and

(c) two or more offices of the corporation may be held by the same person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 133.

Standards of care, etc., of directors, etc.

134. (1) Every director and officer of a corporation in exercising his or her powers and discharging his or her duties shall,

(a) act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the corporation; and

(b) exercise the care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would exercise in comparable circumstances.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 134 (1).

Duty to comply with Act, etc.

(2) Every director and officer of a corporation shall comply with this Act, the regulations, articles, by-laws and any unanimous shareholder agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 134 (2).

Cannot contract out of liability

(3) Subject to subsection 108 (5), no provision in a contract, the articles, the by-laws or a resolution relieves a director or officer from the duty to act in accordance with this Act and the regulations or relieves him or her from liability for a breach thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 134 (3).

Consent of director at meeting

135. (1) A director who is present at a meeting of directors or committee of directors is deemed to have consented to any resolution passed or action taken thereat unless the director,

(a) requests that his or her dissent be or his or her dissent is entered in the minutes of the meeting;

(b) sends a written dissent to the secretary of the meeting before the meeting is terminated; or

(c) sends a dissent by registered mail or delivers it to the registered office of the corporation immediately after the meeting is terminated.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 135 (1).

Idem

(2) A director who votes for or consents to a resolution is not entitled to dissent under subsection (1).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 135 (2).

Idem

(3) A director who was not present at a meeting at which a resolution was passed or action taken is deemed to have consented thereto unless within seven days after becoming aware of the resolution the director,

(a) causes his or her dissent to be placed with the minutes of the meeting; or

(b) sends his or her dissent by registered mail or delivers it to the registered office of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 135 (3).

Entitled to rely on statements, etc.

(4) A director is not liable under section 130 or 134 if the director relies in good faith upon,

(a) financial statements of the corporation represented to him or her by an officer of the corporation or in a written report of the auditor of the corporation to present fairly the financial position of the corporation in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; or

(b) a report of a lawyer, accountant, engineer, appraiser or other person whose profession lends credibility to a statement made by any such person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 135 (4).

Indemnification of directors

136. (1) A corporation may indemnify a director or officer of the corporation, a former director or officer of the corporation or a person who acts or acted at the corporation’s request as a director or officer of a body corporate of which the corporation is or was a shareholder or creditor, and his or her heirs and legal representatives, against all costs, charges and expenses, including an amount paid to settle an action or satisfy a judgment, reasonably incurred by him or her in respect of any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding to which he or she is made a party by reason of being or having been a director or officer of such corporation or body corporate, if,

(a) he or she acted honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the corporation; and

(b) in the case of a criminal or administrative action or proceeding that is enforced by a monetary penalty, he or she had reasonable grounds for believing that his or her conduct was lawful.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 136 (1).

Idem

(2) A corporation may, with the approval of the court, indemnify a person referred to in subsection (1) in respect of an action by or on behalf of the corporation or body corporate to procure a judgment in its favour, to which the person is made a party by reason of being or having been a director or an officer of the corporation or body corporate, against all costs, charges and expenses reasonably incurred by the person in connection with such action if he or she fulfils the conditions set out in clauses (1) (a) and (b).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 136 (2).

Idem

(3) Despite anything in this section, a person referred to in subsection (1) is entitled to indemnity from the corporation in respect of all costs, charges and expenses reasonably incurred by the person in connection with the defence of any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding to which he or she is made a party by reason of being or having been a director or officer of the corporation or body corporate, if the person seeking indemnity,

(a) was substantially successful on the merits in his or her defence of the action or proceeding; and

(b) fulfils the conditions set out in clauses (1) (a) and (b).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 136 (3).

Liability insurance

(4) A corporation may purchase and maintain insurance for the benefit of any person referred to in subsection (1) against any liability incurred by the person,

(a) in his or her capacity as a director or officer of the corporation, except where the liability relates to the person’s failure to act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the corporation; or

(b) in his or her capacity as a director or officer of another body corporate where the person acts or acted in that capacity at the corporation’s request, except where the liability relates to the person’s failure to act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 136 (4).

Application to court

(5) A corporation or a person referred to in subsection (1) may apply to the court for an order approving an indemnity under this section and the court may so order and make any further order it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 136 (5).

Idem

(6) Upon an application under subsection (5), the court may order notice to be given to any interested person and such person is entitled to appear and be heard in person or by counsel.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 136 (6).

Remuneration of directors

137. Subject to the articles, the by-laws or any unanimous shareholder agreement, the directors of a corporation may fix the remuneration of the directors, officers and employees of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 137.

PART X
INSIDER LIABILITY

Insider liability

138. (1) In this Part,

“corporation” means a corporation that is not an offering corporation; (“société”)

“insider” means, with respect to a corporation,

(a) the corporation,

(b) an affiliate of the corporation,

(c) a director or officer of the corporation,

(d) a person who beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, more than 10 per cent of the voting securities of the corporation or who exercises control or direction over more than 10 per cent of the votes attached to the voting securities of the corporation,

(e) a person employed or retained by the corporation, or

(f) a person who receives specific confidential information from a person described in this definition or in subsection (3), including a person described in this clause, and who has knowledge that the person giving the information is a person described in this definition or in subsection (3), including a person described in this clause; (“initié”)

“security” includes a warrant. (“valeur mobilière”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 138 (1).

Insider

(2) For the purposes of this Part,

(a) a director or officer of a body corporate that is an insider of a corporation is deemed to be an insider of the corporation;

(b) a director or officer of a body corporate that is a subsidiary is deemed to be an insider of its holding corporation;

(c) a person is deemed to own beneficially, voting securities beneficially owned by a body corporate controlled by the person directly or indirectly; and

(d) a body corporate is deemed to own beneficially, voting securities beneficially owned by its affiliates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 138 (2).

Idem

(3) For the purposes of this Part,

(a) where a body corporate becomes an insider of a corporation, or enters into a business combination with a corporation, a director or an officer of the body corporate or a shareholder of the body corporate who is a person referred to in clause (d) of the definition of “insider” in subsection (1) is deemed to have been an insider of the corporation for the previous six months or for such shorter period as he or she was a director, an officer or such a shareholder of the body corporate; and

(b) where a corporation becomes an insider of a body corporate or enters into a business combination with a body corporate, a director or an officer of the body corporate or a shareholder of the body corporate who is a person referred to in clause (d) of the definition of “insider” in subsection (1) is deemed to have been an insider of the corporation for the previous six months or for such shorter period as he or she was a director, an officer or such a shareholder of the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 138 (3).

Business combination

(4) In subsection (3),

“business combination” means an acquisition of all or substantially all the property of one body corporate by another or an amalgamation of two or more bodies corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 138 (4).

Liability of insider

(5) An insider who, in connection with a transaction in a security of the corporation or any of its affiliates, makes use of any specific confidential information for the insider’s own benefit or advantage that, if generally known, might reasonably be expected to affect materially the value of the security,

(a) is liable to compensate any person for any direct loss suffered by that person as a result of the transaction, unless the information was known or in the exercise of reasonable diligence should have been known to that person; and

(b) is accountable to the corporation for any direct benefit or advantage received or receivable by the insider as a result of the transaction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 138 (5).

(6) Repealed:  2002, c. 24, Sched. B, s. 25.

PART XI
BOOKS AND RECORDS

Records

139. (1) Where this Act requires a record to be kept by a corporation, it may be kept in a bound or looseleaf book or may be entered or recorded by any system of mechanical or electronic data processing or any other information storage device.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 139 (1).

Guard against falsification of records

(2) The corporation shall,

(a) take adequate precautions, appropriate to the means used, for guarding against the risk of falsifying the information recorded; and

(b) provide means for making the information available in an accurate and intelligible form within a reasonable time to any person lawfully entitled to examine the records.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 139 (2).

Admissibility of records in evidence

(3) The bound or looseleaf book or, where the record is not kept in a bound or looseleaf book, the information in the form in which it is made available under clause (2) (b) is admissible in evidence as proof, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, of all facts stated therein, before and after dissolution of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 139 (3).

False information

(4) No person shall remove, withhold or destroy information required by this Act or the regulations to be recorded, or,

(a) record or assist in recording any information in a record; or

(b) make information purporting to be accurate available in a form referred to in clause (2) (b),

knowing it to be untrue.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 139 (4).

Records, duties of corporation

140. (1) A corporation shall prepare and maintain, at its registered office or at such other place in Ontario designated by the directors,

(a) the articles and the by-laws and all amendments thereto, and a copy of any unanimous shareholder agreement known to the directors;

(b) minutes of meetings and resolutions of shareholders;

(c) a register of directors in which are set out the names and residence addresses, while directors, including the street and number, if any, of all persons who are or have been directors of the corporation with the several dates on which each became or ceased to be a director; and

(d) a securities register complying with section 141.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 140 (1).

Idem

(2) In addition to the records described in subsection (1), a corporation shall prepare and maintain,

(a) adequate accounting records; and

(b) records containing minutes of meetings and resolutions of the directors and any committee thereof,

but, provided the retention requirements of any taxing authority of Ontario, the government of Canada or any other jurisdiction to which the corporation is subject have been satisfied, the accounting records mentioned in clause (a) need only be retained by the corporation for six years from the end of the last fiscal period to which they relate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 140 (2).

Interpretation

(3) For the purposes of clause (1) (b) and subsection (2), where a body corporate is continued under this Act, “records” includes similar records required by law to be maintained by the body corporate before it was so continued.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 140 (3).

Securities register

141. (1) A corporation shall prepare and maintain at its registered office, or at any other place in Ontario designated by the directors, a securities register in which it records the securities issued by it in registered form, showing with respect to each class or series of securities,

(a) the names, alphabetically arranged of persons who,

(i) are or have been within six years registered as shareholders of the corporation, the address including the street and number, if any, of every such person while a holder, and the number and class of shares registered in the name of such holder,

(ii) are or have been within six years registered as holders of debt obligations of the corporation, the address including the street and number, if any, of every such person while a holder, and the class or series and principal amount of the debt obligations registered in the name of such holder, or

(iii) are or have been within six years registered as holders of warrants of the corporation, other than warrants exercisable within one year from the date of issue, the address including the street and number, if any, of every such person while a registered holder, and the class or series and number of warrants registered in the name of such holder; and

(b) the date and particulars of the issue of each security and warrant.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 141 (1).

Register of transfers

(2) A corporation shall cause to be kept a register of transfers in which all transfers of securities issued by the corporation in registered form and the date and other particulars of each transfer shall be set out.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 141 (2).

Definition

(3) In this section and in section 143,

“registered form” has the same meaning as in Part VI.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 141 (3).

Transfer agents

142. For each class of securities and warrants issued by it, a corporation may appoint,

(a) a trustee, transfer agent or other agent to keep the securities register and the register of transfers and one or more persons or agents to keep branch registers; and

(b) a registrar, trustee or agent to maintain a record of issued security certificates and warrants,

and, subject to section 48, one person may be appointed for the purposes of both clauses (a) and (b) in respect of all securities and warrants of the corporation or any class or classes thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 142.

Registers, general

143. (1) The securities register and the register of transfers shall be kept at the registered office of a corporation or at such other places in Ontario designated by the directors, and the branch register or registers of transfers may be kept at such offices of the corporation or other places, either within or outside Ontario, designated by the directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 143 (1).

Valid registration

(2) Registration of the transfer of a security or warrant of a corporation in the register of transfers or a branch register of transfers is a complete and valid registration for all purposes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 143 (2).

Entry in branch transfer register

(3) In each branch register of transfers there shall be recorded only the particulars of the transfers of securities or warrants registered in that branch register of transfers.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 143 (3).

Entry in register of transfers

(4) Particulars of every transfer of securities and warrants registered in every branch register of transfers shall be recorded in the register of transfers.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 143 (4).

Documents not required to be produced

(5) A corporation or a person appointed under section 142 is not required to produce,

(a) any security certificate or warrant that is not in registered form; or

(b) any security certificate or warrant that is in registered form after six years,

(i) in the case of a share certificate, from the date of its cancellation,

(ii) in the case of a warrant, from the date of its transfer or exercise, whichever occurs first, or

(iii) in the case of a certificate representing a debt obligation, from the date of cancellation of such certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 143 (5).

Records open to examination by directors

144. (1) The records mentioned in sections 140 and 141 shall, during normal business hours of a corporation, be open to examination by any director and shall, except as provided in sections 140 and 143 and in subsections (2) and (3) of this section, be kept at the registered office of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 144 (1).

Records of account at branch

(2) A corporation may keep at any place where it carries on business such parts of the accounting records as relate to the operations, business and assets and liabilities of the corporation carried on, supervised or accounted for at such place, but there shall be kept at the registered office of the corporation or such other place as is authorized under this section such records as will enable the directors to ascertain quarterly with reasonable accuracy the financial position of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 144 (2).

Off-site records

(3) A corporation may keep all or any of the records mentioned in subsection (1) at a place other than the registered office of the corporation if the records are available for inspection during regular office hours at the registered office by means of a computer terminal or other electronic technology.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (17).

Rescission of orders made under subs. (3)

(4) The Director may by order upon such terms as the Director thinks fit rescind any order made under subsection (3) or any order made by the Lieutenant Governor in Council or the Minister under a predecessor of that subsection.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 144 (4).

Examination of records by shareholders and creditors

145. (1) Shareholders and creditors of a corporation, their agents and legal representatives may examine the records referred to in subsection 140 (1) during the usual business hours of the corporation, and may take extracts therefrom, free of charge, and, where the corporation is an offering corporation, any other person may do so upon payment of a reasonable fee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 145 (1).

Copy

(2) A shareholder of a corporation is entitled upon request and without charge to one copy of the articles and by-laws and of any unanimous shareholder agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 145 (2).

List of shareholders

146. (1) Shareholders and creditors of a corporation, their agents and legal representatives and, where the corporation is an offering corporation, any other person, upon payment of a reasonable fee and upon sending to the corporation or its transfer agent the statutory declaration referred to in subsection (6), may require the corporation or its transfer agent to furnish a basic list setting out the names of the shareholders of the corporation, the number of shares of each class and series owned by each shareholder and the address of each shareholder, all as shown on the records of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (1).

Idem

(2) The basic list referred to in subsection (1) shall be furnished to the applicant as soon as is practicable and, when furnished, shall be as current as is practicable having regard to the form in which the securities register of the corporation is maintained, but, in any case, shall be furnished not more than ten days following the receipt by the corporation or its transfer agent of the statutory declaration referred to in subsection (1) and shall be made up to a date not more than ten days before the date on which it is actually furnished.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (2).

Supplemental lists

(3) A person requiring a corporation to supply a basic list may, if the person states in the statutory declaration referred to in subsection (1) that the person requires supplemental lists, require the corporation or its agent upon payment of a reasonable fee to furnish supplemental lists setting out any changes from the basic list in the names or addresses of the shareholders and the number of shares owned by each shareholder for each business day following the date to which the basic list is made up.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (3).

Idem

(4) The corporation or its agent shall furnish a supplemental list required under subsection (3),

(a) on the date the basic list is furnished, where the information relates to changes that took place prior to that date; and

(b) on the business day following the day to which the supplemental list relates, where the information relates to changes that take place on or after the date the basic list is furnished.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (4).

List of option holders

(5) A person requiring a corporation to supply a basic or supplemental list may also require the corporation to include in that list the name and address of any known holder of an option or right to acquire shares of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (5).

Statutory declaration

(6) The statutory declaration required under subsection (1) shall state,

(a) the name and address including street and number, if any, of the applicant and whether the applicant is a shareholder, creditor or any other person referred to in the subsection;

(b) the name and address including street and number, if any, for service of the body corporate if the applicant is a body corporate; and

(c) that the basic list and any supplemental lists shall be used only as permitted under subsection (8).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (6).

Idem

(7) If the applicant is a body corporate, the statutory declaration shall be made by a director or officer of the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (7).

Use of list

(8) A list of shareholders obtained under this section shall not be used by any person except in connection with,

(a) an effort to influence the voting by shareholders of the corporation;

(b) an offer to acquire shares of the corporation; or

(c) any other matter relating to the affairs of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 146 (8).

Trafficking in lists

147. No person shall offer for sale or sell or purchase or otherwise traffic in a list or a copy of a list of all or any of the holders of securities or warrants of a corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 147.

PART XII
AUDITORS AND FINANCIAl STATEMENTS

Exemption from audit requirements

148. In respect of a financial year of a corporation, the corporation is exempt from the requirements of this Part regarding the appointment and duties of an auditor if,

(a) the corporation is not an offering corporation; and

(b) all of the shareholders consent in writing to the exemption in respect of that year.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 23.

Auditors

149. (1) The shareholders of a corporation at their first annual or special meeting shall appoint one or more auditors to hold office until the close of the first or next annual meeting, as the case may be, and, if the shareholders fail to do so, the directors shall forthwith make such appointment or appointments.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (1).

Idem

(2) The shareholders shall at each annual meeting appoint one or more auditors to hold office until the close of the next annual meeting and, if an appointment is not so made, the auditor in office continues in office until a successor is appointed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (2).

Casual vacancy

(3) The directors may fill any casual vacancy in the office of auditor, but, while such vacancy continues, the surviving or continuing auditor, if any, may act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (3).

Removal of auditor

(4) The shareholders may, except where the auditor has been appointed by order of the court under subsection (8), by resolution passed by a majority of the votes cast at a special meeting duly called for the purpose, remove an auditor before the expiration of the auditor’s term of office, and shall by a majority of the votes cast at that meeting appoint a replacement for the remainder of the auditor’s term.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (4).

Notice to auditor

(5) Before calling a special meeting for the purpose specified in subsection (4) or an annual or special meeting where the board is not recommending the reappointment of the incumbent auditor, the corporation shall, fifteen days or more before the mailing of the notice of the meeting, give to the auditor,

(a) written notice of the intention to call the meeting, specifying therein the date on which the notice of the meeting is proposed to be mailed; and

(b) a copy of all material proposed to be sent to shareholders in connection with the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (5).

Right of auditor to make representations

(6) An auditor has the right to make to the corporation, three days or more before the mailing of the notice of the meeting, representations in writing, concerning,

(a) the auditor’s proposed removal as auditor;

(b) the appointment or election of another person to fill the office of auditor; or

(c) the auditor’s resignation as auditor,

and the corporation, at its expense, shall forward with the notice of the meeting a copy of such representations to each shareholders entitled to receive notice of the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (6).

Remuneration

(7) The remuneration of an auditor appointed by the shareholders shall be fixed by the shareholders, or by the directors if they are authorized so to do by the shareholders, and the remuneration of an auditor appointed by the directors shall be fixed by the directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (7).

Appointment by court

(8) If a corporation does not have an auditor, the court may, upon the application of a shareholder or the Director, appoint and fix the remuneration of an auditor to hold office until an auditor is appointed by the shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (8).

Notice of appointment

(9) The corporation shall give notice in writing to an auditor of the auditor’s appointment forthwith after the appointment is made.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 149 (9).

Resignation of auditor

150. A resignation of an auditor becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the corporation or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 150.

Auditor’s attendance at shareholders’ meetings

151. (1) The auditor of a corporation is entitled to receive notice of every meeting of shareholders and, at the expense of the corporation, to attend and be heard thereat on matters relating to the auditor’s duties.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (1).

Auditor’s attendance may be required

(2) If any director or shareholder of a corporation, whether or not the shareholder is entitled to vote at the meeting, gives written notice, not less than five days or more before a meeting of shareholders, to the auditor or a former auditor of the corporation, the auditor or former auditor shall attend the meeting at the expense of the corporation and answer questions relating to the auditor’s duties.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (2).

Notice to corporation

(3) A director or shareholder who sends a notice referred to in subsection (2) shall send concurrently a copy of the notice to the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (3).

Replacing auditor

(4) No person shall accept appointment or consent to be appointed as auditor of a corporation if the person is replacing an auditor who has resigned, been removed or whose term of office has expired or is about to expire until the person has requested and received from that auditor a written statement of the circumstances and the reasons why, in that auditor’s opinion, that auditor is to be replaced.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (4).

Idem

(5) Despite subsection (4), a person otherwise qualified may accept appointment or consent to be appointed as auditor of a corporation if, within fifteen days after making the request referred to in that subsection, the person does not receive a reply.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (5).

Idem

(6) Any interested person may apply to the court for an order declaring an auditor to be disqualified and the office of auditor to be vacant if the auditor has not complied with subsection (4), unless subsection (5) applies with respect to the appointment of the auditor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (6).

Statement by auditor privileged

(7) Any oral or written statement or report made under this Act by the auditor or former auditor of the corporation has qualified privilege.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 151 (7).

Disqualification as auditor

152. (1) Subject to subsection (5), a person is disqualified from being an auditor of a corporation if the person is not independent of the corporation, all of its affiliates, or of the directors or officers of the corporation and its affiliates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 152 (1).

Independence

(2) For the purposes of this section,

(a) independence is a question of fact; and

(b) a person is deemed not to be independent if the person or the person’s business partner,

(i) is a business partner, director, officer or employee of the corporation or any of its affiliates, or a business partner of any director, officer or employee of the corporation or any of its affiliates,

(ii) beneficially owns directly or indirectly or exercises control or direction over a material interest in the securities of the corporation or any of its affiliates, or

(iii) has been a receiver, receiver and manager, liquidator or trustee in bankruptcy of the corporation or any of its affiliates within two years of the person’s proposed appointment as auditor of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 152 (2).

Resignation by auditor

(3) An auditor who becomes disqualified under this section shall, subject to subsection (5), resign forthwith upon becoming aware of such disqualification.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 152 (3).

Application to court

(4) An interested person may apply to the court for an order declaring an auditor to be disqualified under this section and the office of auditor to be vacant.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 152 (4).

Idem

(5) An interested person may apply to the court for an order exempting an auditor from disqualification under this section and the court may, if it is satisfied that an exemption would not unfairly prejudice the shareholders, make an exemption order on such terms as it thinks fit, which order may have retrospective effect.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 152 (5).

Commencement

(6) Subsection (5) comes into force on a day to be named by proclamation of the Lieutenant Governor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 152 (6).

Examination by auditor

153. (1) An auditor of a corporation shall make such examination of the financial statements required by this Act to be placed before shareholders as is necessary to enable the auditor to report thereon and the auditor shall report as prescribed and in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (1).

Reporting error

(2) A director or an officer of a corporation shall forthwith notify the audit committee and the auditor or the former auditor of any error or misstatement of which he or she becomes aware in a financial statement that the auditor or the former auditor has reported upon if the error or misstatement in all the circumstances appears to be significant.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (2).

Idem

(3) If the auditor or former auditor of a corporation is notified or becomes aware of an error or misstatement in a financial statement upon which he or she has reported, and if in his or her opinion the error or misstatement is material, the auditor or former auditor shall inform each director accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (3).

Amendment of auditor’s report

(4) When under subsection (3) the auditor or former auditor informs the directors of an error or misstatement in a financial statement, the directors shall within a reasonable time,

(a) prepare and issue revised financial statements; or

(b) otherwise inform the shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (4).

Right of access

(5) Upon the demand of an auditor of a corporation, the present or former directors, officers, employees or agents of the corporation shall furnish such,

(a) information and explanations; and

(b) access to records, documents, books, accounts and vouchers of the corporation or any of its subsidiaries,

as are, in the opinion of the auditor, necessary to enable the auditor to make the examination and report required under this section and that the directors, officers, employees or agents are reasonably able to furnish.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (5).

Furnishing information

(6) Upon the demand of the auditor of a corporation, the directors of the corporation shall,

(a) obtain from the present or former directors, officers, employees and agents of any subsidiary of the corporation the information and explanations that the present or former directors, officers, employees and agents are reasonably able to furnish and that are, in the opinion of the auditor, necessary to enable the auditor to make the examination and report required under this section; and

(b) furnish the information and explanations so obtained to the auditor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (6).

Idem

(7) Any oral or written communication under this section between the auditor or former auditor of a corporation and its present or former directors, officers, employees or agents or those of any subsidiary of the corporation, has qualified privilege.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 153 (7).

Information to be laid before annual meeting

154. (1) The directors shall place before each annual meeting of shareholders,

(a) in the case of a corporation that is not an offering corporation, financial statements for the period that began on the date the corporation came into existence and ended not more than six months before the annual meeting or, if the corporation has completed a financial year, the period that began immediately after the end of the last completed financial year and ended not more than six months before the annual meeting;

(b) in the case of a corporation that is an offering corporation, the financial statements required to be filed under the Securities Act and the regulations thereunder relating separately to,

(i) the period that began on the date the corporation came into existence and ended not more than six months before the annual meeting or, if the corporation has completed a financial year, the period that began immediately after the end of the last completed financial year and ended not more than six months before the annual meeting, and

(ii) the immediately preceding financial year, if any;

(c) the report of the auditor, if any, to the shareholders; and

(d) any further information respecting the financial position of the corporation and the results of its operations required by the articles, the by-laws or any unanimous shareholder agreement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 154 (1).

Auditor’s report

(2) Except as provided in subsection 104 (1), the report of the auditor to the shareholders shall be open to inspection at the annual meeting by any shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 154 (2).

Copy of documents to shareholders

(3) A corporation shall, not less than twenty-one days, in the case of an offering corporation, and ten days, in the case of a corporation that is not an offering corporation, before each annual meeting of shareholders or before the signing of a resolution under clause 104 (1) (b) in lieu of the annual meeting, send a copy of the documents referred to in this section to each shareholder, except to a shareholder who has informed the corporation in writing that the shareholder does not wish to receive a copy of those documents.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 154 (3).

Preparation of financial statements

155. The financial statements required under this Act shall be prepared as prescribed by regulation and in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 155.

Filing by offering corporation

156. An offering corporation shall prepare and file with the Commission the financial statements required under Part XVIII of the Securities Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 156.

Financial statements of subsidiaries

157. (1) True copies of the latest financial statements of each subsidiary of a holding corporation shall be kept on hand by the holding corporation at its registered office and shall be open to examination by the shareholders of the holding corporation and their agents and legal representatives who may make extracts therefrom free of charge on request during the normal business hours of the holding corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 157 (1).

Application to court

(2) A corporation may, within fifteen days after a request to examine under subsection (1), apply to the court for an order barring the right of any person to so examine, and the court may, if satisfied that such examination would be detrimental to the corporation or a subsidiary body corporate, bar such right and make any further order it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 157 (2).

Audit committee

158. (1) A corporation that is an offering corporation shall, and any other corporation may, have an audit committee composed of not fewer that three directors of the corporation, a majority of whom are not officers or employees of the corporation or any of its affiliates, to hold office until the next annual meeting of the shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 158 (1).

Idem

(2) An audit committee shall review the financial statements of the corporation and shall report thereon to the board of directors of the corporation before such financial statements are approved under section 159.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 158 (2).

Auditor may attend committee meetings

(3) The auditor of a corporation is entitled to receive notice of every meeting of the audit committee and, at the expense of the corporation, to attend and be heard thereat, and, if so requested by a member of the audit committee, shall attend every meeting of the committee held during the term of office of the auditor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 158 (3).

Calling meetings of committee

(4) The auditor of a corporation or a member of the audit committee may call a meeting of the committee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 158 (4).

Right of auditor to be heard

(5) The auditor of a corporation shall be entitled to attend at the expense of the corporation and be heard at meetings of the board of directors of the corporation on matters relating to the auditor’s duties.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 158 (5).

Approval by directors

159. (1) The financial statements shall be approved by the board of directors and the approval shall be evidenced by the signature at the foot of the balance sheet by two of the directors duly authorized to sign or by the director where there is only one, and the auditor’s report, unless the corporation is exempt under section 148, shall be attached to or accompany the financial statements.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 159 (1).

Publishing, etc., copies of financial statements

(2) A corporation shall not issue, publish or circulate copies of the financial statements, referred to in section 154 unless the financial statements are,

(a) approved and signed in accordance with subsection (1); and

(b) accompanied by the report of the auditor of the corporation, if any.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 159 (2).

Interim financial statement

160. (1) An offering corporation shall send to each shareholder a copy of an interim financial statement required to be filed under the Securities Act and the regulations thereunder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 160 (1).

Idem

(2) The interim financial statement required by subsection (1) shall be sent to each shareholder, within sixty days of the date to which it is made up, at the shareholder’s latest address as shown on the records of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 160 (2).

PART XIII
INVESTIGATION

Investigation

161. (1) A security holder of a corporation and, in the case of an offering corporation, the Commission may apply, without notice or upon such notice as the court may require, to the court for an order directing an investigation to be made of the corporation and any of its affiliates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 161 (1).

Idem

(2) Where, upon an application under subsection (1), it appears to the court that,

(a) the business of the corporation or any of its affiliates is or has been carried on with intent to defraud any person;

(b) the business or affairs of the corporation or any of its affiliates are or have been carried on or conducted, or the powers of the directors are or have been exercised, in a manner that is oppressive or unfairly prejudicial to, or that unfairly disregards, the interests of a security holder;

(c) the corporation or any of its affiliates was formed for a fraudulent or unlawful purpose or is to be dissolved for a fraudulent or unlawful purpose; or

(d) persons concerned with the formation, business or affairs of the corporation or any of its affiliates have in connection therewith acted fraudulently or dishonestly,

the court may order an investigation to be made of the corporation and any of its affiliates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 161 (2).

Notice

(3) If a security holder makes an application under subsection (1) and the corporation is an offering corporation, the security holder shall give the Commission reasonable notice thereof and the Commission is entitled to appear and be heard in person or by counsel.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (19).

Security for costs not required

(4) An applicant under this section is not required to give security for costs.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 161 (4).

Closed hearing

(5) The hearing of an application made without notice under this section shall be closed to the public.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 161 (5).

No publication without consent

(6) No person may publish anything relating to an application under this section except with the authorization of the court or the written consent of the corporation being investigated.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 161 (6).

Matters that may be covered by court order

162. (1) In connection with an investigation under this Part, the court may make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order to investigate;

(b) an order appointing and fixing the remuneration of an inspector or replacing an inspector;

(c) an order determining the notice to be given to any interested person, or dispensing with notice to any person;

(d) an order authorizing an inspector to enter any premises in which the court is satisfied there might be relevant information, and to examine anything and make copies of any document or record found on the premises;

(e) an order requiring any person to produce documents or records to the inspector;

(f) an order authorizing an inspector to conduct a hearing, administer oaths and examine any person upon oath, and prescribing rules for the conduct of the hearing;

(g) an order requiring any person to attend a hearing conducted by an inspector and to give evidence upon oath;

(h) an order giving directions to an inspector or any interested person on any matter arising in the investigation;

(i) an order requiring an inspector to make an interim or final report to the court;

(j) an order determining whether a report of an inspector should be made available for public inspection and ordering that copies be sent to any person the court designates;

(k) an order requiring an inspector to discontinue an investigation;

(l) an order requiring the corporation to pay the costs of the investigation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 162 (1).

Inspector’s report

(2) An inspector shall send to the Director and, where an offering corporation is involved, the Commission, a copy of every report made by the inspector under this Part which, subject to clause (1) (j), shall be placed on the corporation file for public inspection.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 162 (2).

Powers of inspector

163. (1) An inspector under this Part has the powers set out in the order appointing the inspector.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 163 (1).

Idem

(2) In addition to the powers set out in the order referred to in subsection (1), an inspector appointed to investigate a corporation may furnish to, or exchange information and otherwise co-operate with, any public official in Canada or elsewhere who is authorized to exercise investigatory powers and who is investigating, in respect of the corporation, any allegation of improper conduct that is the same as, or similar to, the conduct described in subsection 161 (2).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 163 (2).

Production of order

(3) An inspector shall produce upon request to an interested person a copy of any order made under subsection 162 (1).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 163 (3).

Rights at hearing

164. (1) Any interested person may apply to the court for an order that a hearing conducted under this Part be closed to the public and for directions on any matter arising in the investigation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 164 (1).

Right to counsel

(2) A person whose conduct is being investigated or who is being examined at a hearing conducted by an inspector under this Part has a right to be represented by counsel.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 164 (2).

Privileged statements

165. Any oral or written statement or report made by an inspector or any other person in an investigation under this Part has absolute privilege.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 165.

Solicitor-client privilege

166. Nothing in this Part shall be construed to affect the privilege that exists in respect of communications between a solicitor and his or her client.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 166.

Inquiries by Director

167. The Director may make inquiries of any person relating to compliance with this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 167.

PART XIV
FUNDAMENTAL CHANGES

Amendments

168. (1) Subject to sections 170 and 171, a corporation may from time to time amend its articles to add, change or remove any provision that is permitted by this Act to be, or that is, set out in its articles, including without limiting the generality of the foregoing, to,

(a) change its name;

(b) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (20).

(c) add, change or remove any restriction upon the business or businesses that the corporation may carry on or upon the powers that the corporation may exercise;

(d) add, change or remove any maximum number of shares that the corporation is authorized to issue or any maximum consideration for which any shares of the corporation are authorized to be issued;

(e) create new classes of shares;

(f) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (20).

(g) change the designation of all or any of its shares, and add, change or remove any rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions, including rights to accrued dividends, in respect of all or any of its shares, whether issued or unissued;

(h) change the shares of any class or series, whether issued or unissued, into a different number of shares of the same class or series or into the same or a different number of shares of other classes or series;

(i) divide a class of shares, whether issued or unissued, into series and fix the number of shares in each series and the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions thereof;

(j) authorize the directors to divide any class of unissued shares into series and fix the number of shares in each series and the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions thereof;

(k) authorize the directors to change the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to unissued shares of any series;

(l) revoke, diminish or enlarge any authority conferred under clauses (j) and (k);

(m) subject to sections 120 and 125, increase or decrease the number, or minimum or maximum number, of directors; and

(n) add, change or remove restrictions on the issue, transfer or ownership of shares of any class or series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 168 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (20).

Idem

(2) Where the directors are authorized by the articles to divide any class of unissued shares into series and determine the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions thereof, they may authorize the amendment of the articles to so provide.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 168 (2).

Revocation of resolution

(3) The directors of a corporation may, if so authorized by a special resolution effecting an amendment under this section, revoke the resolution without further approval of the shareholders at any time prior to the endorsement by the Director of a certificate of amendment of articles in respect of such amendment.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 168 (3).

Change of number name

(4) Despite subsection (1), where a corporation has a number name, the directors may amend its articles to change that name to a name that is not a number name.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 168 (4).

Authorization

(5) An amendment under subsection (1) shall be authorized by a special resolution and an amendment under subsection (2) or (4) may be authorized by a resolution of the directors.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 168 (5).

Special Act corporations excepted

(6) This section does not apply to a corporation incorporated by special Act, except that a corporation incorporated by special Act, including a corporation to which The Railways Act, being chapter 331 of the Revised Statutes of Ontario, 1950, applies, may under this section amend its articles to change its name.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 168 (6).

Proposal to amend articles

169. (1) The directors or any shareholder who is entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders may, in accordance with section 99, make a proposal to amend the articles.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 169 (1).

Idem

(2) Notice of a meeting of shareholders at which a proposal to amend the articles is to be considered shall set out the proposed amendment and, where applicable, shall state that a dissenting shareholder is entitled to be paid the fair value of the shares in accordance with section 185, but failure to make that statement does not invalidate an amendment.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 169 (2).

Authorization for variation of rights of special shareholders

170. (1) The holders of shares of a class or, subject to subsection (2), of a series are, unless the articles otherwise provide in the case of an amendment referred to in clause (a), (b) or (e), entitled to vote separately as a class or series upon a proposal to amend the articles to,

(a) increase or decrease any maximum number of authorized shares of such class or series, or increase any maximum number of authorized shares of a class or series having rights or privileges equal or superior to the shares of such class or series;

(b) effect an exchange, reclassification or cancellation of the shares of such class or series;

(c) add to, remove or change the rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached to the shares of such class or series and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(i) remove or change prejudicially rights to accrued dividends or rights to cumulative dividends,

(ii) add, remove or change prejudicially redemption rights or sinking fund provisions,

(iii) reduce or remove a dividend preference or a liquidation preference, or

(iv) add, remove or change prejudicially conversion privileges, options, voting, transfer or pre-emptive rights, or rights to acquire securities of a corporation;

(d) add to the rights or privileges of any class or series of shares having rights or privileges equal or superior to the shares of such class or series;

(e) create a new class or series of shares equal or superior to the shares of such class or series, except in the case of a series under section 25;

(f) make a class or series of shares having rights or privileges inferior to the shares of such class or series equal or superior to the shares of such class or series;

(g) effect an exchange or create a right of exchange of the shares of another class or series into the shares of such class or series; or

(h) add, remove or change restrictions on the issue, transfer or ownership of the shares of such class or series.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 170 (1).

Idem

(2) The holders of a series of shares of a class are entitled to vote separately as a series under subsection (1) only if such series is affected by an amendment in a manner different from other shares of the same class.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 170 (2).

Idem

(3) Subsection (1) applies whether or not shares of a class or series otherwise carry the right to vote.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 170 (3).

Idem

(4) A proposed amendment to the articles referred to in subsection (1) is adopted when the shareholders have approved the amendment by a special resolution of the holders of the shares of each class or series entitled to vote thereon.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 170 (4).

Exception

(5) Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a proposal to amend the articles to add a right or privilege for a holder to convert shares of a class or series into shares of another class or series that is subject to restrictions described in clause 42 (2) (d) but is otherwise equal to the class or series first mentioned.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 170 (5).

Deeming provision

(6) For the purpose of clause (1) (e), a new class of shares, the issue, transfer or ownership of which is to be restricted by an amendment to the articles for the purpose of clause 42 (2) (d) that is otherwise equal to an existing class of shares shall be deemed not to be equal or superior to the existing class of shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 170 (6).

Articles of amendment

171. (1) Articles of amendment in prescribed form shall be sent to the Director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 171 (1).

Application of s. 34 (4, 5)

(2) If an amendment effects or requires a reduction of stated capital, subsections 34 (4) and (5) apply.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 171 (2).

Change of name

(3) No corporation shall change its name if,

(a) the corporation is unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) the realizable value of the corporation’s assets is less than the aggregate of its liabilities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 171 (3).

Certificate of amendment

172. Upon receipt of articles of amendment, the Director shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate of amendment.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 172.

Restated articles of incorporation

173. (1) The directors may at any time restate the articles of incorporation as amended.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 173 (1).

Idem

(2) Restated articles of incorporation in prescribed form shall be sent to the Director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 173 (2).

Restated certificate of incorporation

(3) Upon receipt of restated articles of incorporation, the Director shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the restated certificate of incorporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 173 (3).

Idem

(4) Restated articles of incorporation supersede the original articles of incorporation and all amendments thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 173 (4).

Amalgamation

174. Two or more corporations, including holding or subsidiary corporations, may amalgamate and continue as one corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 174.

Amalgamation agreement

175. (1) Where corporations propose to amalgamate, each such corporation shall enter into an agreement setting out the terms and means of effecting the amalgamation and, in particular, setting out,

(a) the provisions that are required to be included in articles of incorporation under section 5;

(b) subject to subsection (2), the basis upon which and manner in which the holders of the issued shares of each amalgamating corporation are to receive,

(i) securities of the amalgamated corporation,

(ii) money, or

(iii) securities of any body corporate other than the amalgamated corporation,

in the amalgamation;

(c) the manner of payment of money instead of the issue of fractional shares of the amalgamated corporation or of any other body corporate the securities of which are to be received in the amalgamation;

(d) whether the by-laws of the amalgamated corporation are to be those of one of the amalgamating corporations and the address where a copy of the proposed by-laws may be examined; and

(e) such other details as may be necessary to perfect the amalgamation and to provide for the subsequent management and operation of the amalgamated corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 175 (1).

Shares of amalgamating corporation held by another

(2) Where shares of one of the amalgamating corporations are held by or on behalf of another of the amalgamating corporations, the amalgamation agreement shall provide for the cancellation of such shares upon the amalgamation becoming effective without any repayment of capital in respect thereof, and no provision shall be made in the agreement for the conversion of such shares into shares of the amalgamated corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 175 (2).

Submission of amalgamation agreement

176. (1) The directors of each amalgamating corporation shall submit the amalgamation agreement for approval at a meeting of the shareholders of the amalgamating corporation of which they are directors and, subject to subsection (3), of the holders of shares of each class or series entitled to vote thereon.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 176 (1).

Notice of meeting

(2) The notice of the meeting of shareholders of each amalgamating corporation shall include or be accompanied by,

(a) a copy or summary of the amalgamation agreement; and

(b) a statement that a dissenting shareholder is entitled to be paid the fair value of the shares in accordance with section 185, but failure to make that statement does not invalidate an amalgamation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 176 (2).

Voting by class, etc.

(3) The holders of a class or series of shares of an amalgamating corporation, whether or not they are otherwise entitled to vote, are entitled to vote separately as a class or series in respect of an amalgamation if the amalgamation agreement contains a provision that, if contained in a proposed amendment to the articles, would entitle such holders to vote separately as a class or series under section 170.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 176 (3).

Adoption of amalgamation agreement

(4) An amalgamation agreement is adopted when the shareholders of each amalgamating corporation have approved of the amalgamation by a special resolution of the holders of the shares of each class or series entitled to vote thereon.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 176 (4).

Termination of agreement

(5) An amalgamation agreement may provide that at any time before the endorsement of a certificate of amalgamation the agreement may be terminated by the directors of an amalgamating corporation, despite approval of the agreement by the shareholders of all or any of the amalgamating corporations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 176 (5).

Amalgamations involving holding corporation

177. (1) A holding corporation and one or more of its subsidiary corporations may amalgamate and continue as one corporation without complying with sections 175 and 176 if,

(a) the amalgamation is approved by a resolution of the directors of each amalgamating corporation;

(a.1) all of the issued shares of each amalgamating subsidiary corporation are held by one or more of the other amalgamating corporations; and

(b) the resolutions provide that,

(i) the shares of each amalgamating subsidiary corporation shall be cancelled without any repayment of capital in respect thereof,

(i.1) the by-laws of the amalgamated corporation shall be the same as the by-laws of the amalgamating holding corporation,

(ii) except as may be prescribed, the articles of amalgamation shall be the same as the articles of the amalgamating holding corporation, and

(iii) no securities shall be issued and no assets shall be distributed by the amalgamated corporation in connection with the amalgamation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 177 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (21); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 24.

Amalgamation of subsidiaries

(2) Two or more wholly-owned subsidiary corporations of the same holding body corporate may amalgamate and continue as one corporation without complying with sections 175 and 176 if,

(a) the amalgamation is approved by a resolution of the directors of each amalgamating corporation; and

(b) the resolutions provide that,

(i) the shares of all but one of the amalgamating subsidiary corporations shall be cancelled without any repayment of capital in respect thereof,

(i.1) the by-laws of the amalgamated corporation shall be the same as the by-laws of the amalgamating subsidiary corporation whose shares are not cancelled,

(ii) except as may be prescribed, the articles of amalgamation shall be the same as the articles of the amalgamating subsidiary corporation whose shares are not cancelled, and

(iii) the stated capital of the amalgamating subsidiary corporations whose shares are cancelled shall be added to the stated capital of the amalgamating subsidiary corporation whose shares are not cancelled.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 177 (2); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (22).

Articles of amalgamation

178. (1) Subject to subsection 176 (5), after an amalgamation has been adopted under section 176 or approved under section 177, articles of amalgamation in prescribed form shall be sent to the Director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 178 (1).

Director’s statement

(2) The articles of amalgamation shall have attached thereto a statement of a director or an officer of each amalgamating corporation stating that,

(a) there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(i) each amalgamating corporation is and the amalgamated corporation will be able to pay its liabilities as they become due, and

(ii) the realizable value of the amalgamated corporation’s assets will not be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and stated capital of all classes;

(b) there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(i) no creditor will be prejudiced by the amalgamation, or

(ii) adequate notice has been given to all known creditors of the amalgamating corporations;

(c) the grounds upon which the objections of all creditors who have notified the corporation that they object to the amalgamation, setting forth with reasonable particularity the grounds for such objections, are either frivolous or vexatious; and

(d) the corporation has given notice to each person who has, in the manner referred to in clause (c), notified the corporation of an objection to the amalgamation, that,

(i) the grounds upon which the person’s objection is based are considered to be frivolous or vexatious, and

(ii) a creditor of a corporation who objects to an amalgamation has the status of a complainant under section 248.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 178 (2).

Notice

(3) For the purposes of subsection (2), adequate notice is given if,

(a) a notice in writing is sent to each known creditor having a claim against the corporation that exceeds $2,500, at the last address of the creditor known to the corporation;

(b) a notice is published once in a newspaper published or distributed in the place where the corporation has its registered office; and

(c) each notice states that the corporation intends to amalgamate with one or more specified corporations in accordance with this Act unless a creditor of the corporation objects to the amalgamation within thirty days from the date of the notice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 178 (3).

Certificate of amalgamation

(4) Upon receipt of articles of amalgamation, the Director shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of amalgamation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 178 (4).

Effect of certificate

179. Upon the articles of amalgamation becoming effective,

(a) the amalgamating corporations are amalgamated and continue as one corporation under the terms and conditions prescribed in the amalgamation agreement;

(b) the amalgamated corporation possesses all the property, rights, privileges and franchises and is subject to all liabilities, including civil, criminal and quasi-criminal, and all contracts, disabilities and debts of each of the amalgamating corporations;

(c) a conviction against, or ruling, order or judgment in favour or against an amalgamating corporation may be enforced by or against the amalgamated corporation;

(d) the articles of amalgamation are deemed to be the articles of incorporation of the amalgamated corporation and, except for the purposes of subsection 117 (1), the certificate of amalgamation is deemed to be the certificate of incorporation of the amalgamated corporation; and

(e) the amalgamated corporation shall be deemed to be the party plaintiff or the party defendant, as the case may be, in any civil action commenced by or against an amalgamating corporation before the amalgamation has become effective.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 179.

Articles of continuance

180. (1) A body corporate incorporated under the laws of any jurisdiction other than Ontario may, if it appears to the Director to be thereunto authorized by the laws of the jurisdiction in which it was incorporated, apply to the Director for a certificate of continuance.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (1).

Idem

(2) Articles of continuance in prescribed form shall be sent to the Director together with any other prescribed documents.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (2).

Amendments to original articles

(3) The articles of continuance shall make any amendments to the original or restated articles of incorporation, articles of amalgamation, letters patent, supplementary letters patent, a special Act and any other instrument by which the body corporate was incorporated and any amendments thereto necessary to make the articles of continuance conform to the laws of Ontario, and may make such other amendments as would be permitted under this Act if the body corporate were incorporated under the laws of Ontario, provided that at least the same shareholder approval has been obtained for such other amendments as would have been required under this Part if the body corporate were incorporated under the laws of Ontario.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (3).

Endorsement of certificate of continuance

(4) Upon receipt of articles of continuance and any other prescribed documents, the Director may, on such terms and subject to such limitations and conditions as the Director considers proper, endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of continuance.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (4).

Effect of certificate

(5) Upon the articles of continuance becoming effective,

(a) the body corporate becomes a corporation to which this Act applies as if it had been incorporated under this Act;

(b) the articles of continuance are deemed to be the articles of incorporation of the continued corporation; and

(c) except for the purposes of subsection 117 (1), the certificate of continuance is deemed to be the certificate of incorporation of the continued corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (5).

Copy of certificate of continuance

(6) The Director shall send a copy of the certificate of continuance to the appropriate official or public body in the jurisdiction in which continuance under the Act was authorized.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (6).

Rights, liabilities, etc., preserved

(7) When a body corporate is continued as a corporation under this Act,

(a) the corporation possesses all the property, rights, privileges and franchises and is subject to all the liabilities, including civil, criminal and quasi-criminal, and all contracts, disabilities and debts of the body corporate;

(b) a conviction against, or ruling, order or judgment in favour of or against, the body corporate may be enforced by or against the corporation; and

(c) the corporation shall be deemed to be the party plaintiff or the party defendant, as the case may be, in any civil action commenced by or against the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (7).

Shares issued before body corporate continued under this Act

(8) Subject to subsection 56 (3), a share of a body corporate issued before the body corporate was continued under this Act shall be deemed to have been issued in compliance with this Act and with the provisions of the articles of continuance, irrespective that the share is not fully paid and of any designation, rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions set out on or referred to in the certificate representing the share, and continuance under this section does not deprive a holder of any right or privilege that the holder claims under, or relieve the holder of any liability in respect of, an issued share.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 180 (8).

Transfer of Ontario corporations

181. (1) Subject to subsection (9), a corporation may, if it is authorized by the shareholders and the Director in accordance with this section, apply to the appropriate official or public body of another jurisdiction requesting that the corporation be continued as if it had been incorporated under the laws of that other jurisdiction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (1).

Notice to shareholders

(2) The notice of the meeting of shareholders shall include or be accompanied by a statement that a dissenting shareholder is entitled to be paid the fair value of the shares in accordance with section 185, but failure to make that statement does not invalidate an authorization under clause (3) (a).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (2).

Application for continuance

(3) An application for continuance becomes authorized,

(a) by the shareholders when the shareholders voting thereon have approved of the continuance by a special resolution; and

(b) by the Director when, following receipt from the corporation of an application in prescribed form, the Director endorses an authorization on the application.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (3).

Authorization by Director

(4) The Director may endorse the authorization if he or she is satisfied that the application is not prohibited by subsection (9).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (4).

Abandoning application

(5) The directors of a corporation may, if authorized by the shareholders, abandon an application without further approval of the shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (5).

Time limit to Director's authorization

(6) The authorization of the Director for an application for continuance expires six months after the date of endorsement of the authorization unless, within the six-month period, the corporation is continued under the laws of the other jurisdiction.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (7).

Filing instrument of continuance

(7) The corporation shall file with the Director a copy of the instrument of continuance issued to it by the other jurisdiction within sixty days after the date of issuance.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (7).

Effective date

(8) This Act ceases to apply to the corporation on the date upon which the corporation is continued under the laws of the other jurisdiction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (8).

Continuance in outside jurisdiction

(9) A corporation shall not apply under subsection (1) to be continued as a body corporate under the laws of another jurisdiction unless those laws provide in effect that,

(a) the property of the corporation continues to be the property of the body corporate;

(b) the body corporate continues to be liable for the obligations of the corporation;

(c) an existing cause of action, claim or liability to prosecution is unaffected;

(d) a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding pending by or against the corporation may be continued to be prosecuted by or against the body corporate; and

(e) a conviction against the corporation may be enforced against the body corporate or a ruling, order or judgment in favour of or against the corporation may be enforced by or against the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 181 (9).

Continuation as co-operative corporation

181.1 (1) A corporation may, if it is authorized by the shareholders and the Director in accordance with this section, apply under the Co-operative Corporations Act to be continued as a co-operative corporation.  1994, c. 17, s. 30.

Notice to shareholders

(2) The notice of the meeting of shareholders to authorize an application under subsection (1) must include or be accompanied by a statement that a dissenting shareholder is entitled to be paid the fair value of the shares in accordance with section 185 but failure to make that statement does not invalidate an authorization under clause (3) (a).  1994, c. 17, s. 30.

Authorization

(3) An application for continuance is authorized,

(a) by the shareholders, when the shareholders voting thereon have approved of the continuance by a special resolution; and

(b) by the Director, when, following receipt from the corporation of an application in the prescribed form, the Director endorses an authorization on the application.  1994, c. 17, s. 30.

Abandoning application

(4) The directors of a corporation may, if authorized by the shareholders, abandon an application without further approval of the shareholders.  1994, c. 17, s. 30.

Time limit to Director’s authorization

(5) The authorization of the Director for an application for continuance expires six months after the date of endorsement of the authorization unless, within the six-month period, the corporation is continued under the Co-operative Corporations Act.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (8).

Certificate to be filed

(6) The corporation shall file with the Director a copy of the certificate of continuance issued to it under the Co-operative Corporations Act within 60 days after the date of issuance.  1994, c. 17, s. 30.

Act ceases to apply

(7) This Act ceases to apply to the corporation on the date upon which the corporation is continued under the Co-operative Corporations Act.  1994, c. 17, s. 30.

Arrangement

182. (1) In this section,

“arrangement”, with respect to a corporation, includes,

(a) a reorganization of the shares of any class or series of the corporation or of the stated capital of any such class or series,

(b) the addition to or removal from the articles of the corporation of any provision that is permitted by this Act to be, or that is, set out in the articles or the change of any such provision,

(c) an amalgamation of the corporation with another corporation,

(d) an amalgamation of a body corporate with a corporation that results in an amalgamated corporation subject to this Act,

(e) a transfer of all or substantially all the property of the corporation to another body corporate in exchange for securities, money or other property of the body corporate,

(f) an exchange of securities of the corporation held by security holders for other securities, money or other property of the corporation or securities, money or other property of another body corporate that is not a take-over bid as defined in Part XX of the Securities Act,

(g) a liquidation or dissolution of the corporation,

(h) any other reorganization or scheme involving the business or affairs of the corporation or of any or all of the holders of its securities or of any options or rights to acquire any of its securities that is, at law, an arrangement, and

(i) any combination of the foregoing.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 182 (1).

Scheme of arrangement

(2) A corporation proposing an arrangement shall prepare, for the approval of the shareholders, a statement thereof setting out in detail what is proposed to be done and the manner in which it is proposed to be done.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 182 (2).

Adoption of arrangement

(3) Subject to any order of the court made under subsection (5), where an arrangement has been approved by shareholders of a corporation and by holders of shares of each class or series entitled to vote separately thereon, in each case by special resolution, the arrangement shall have been adopted by the shareholders of the corporation and the corporation may apply to the court for an order approving the arrangement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 182 (3).

Separate votes

(4) The holders of shares of a class or series of shares of a corporation are not entitled to vote separately as a class or series in respect of an arrangement unless the statement of the arrangement referred to in subsection (2) contains a provision that, if contained in a proposed amendment to the articles, would entitle such holders to vote separately as a class or series under section 170 and, if the statement of the arrangement contains such a provision, such holders are entitled to vote separately on the arrangement whether or not such shares otherwise carry the right to vote.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 182 (4).

Application to court

(5) The corporation may, at any time, apply to the court for advice and directions in connection with an arrangement or proposed arrangement and the court may make such order as it considers appropriate, including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order determining the notice to be given to any interested person or dispensing with notice to any person;

(b) an order requiring a corporation to call, hold and conduct an additional meeting of, or to hold a separate vote of, all or any particular group of holders of any securities or warrants of the corporation in such manner as the court directs;

(c) an order permitting a shareholder to dissent under section 185 if the arrangement is adopted;

(d) an order appointing counsel, at the expense of the corporation, to represent the interests of shareholders;

(e) an order that the arrangement or proposed arrangement shall be deemed not to have been adopted by the shareholders of the corporation unless it has been approved by a specified majority that is greater than two-thirds of the votes cast at a meeting of the holders, or any particular group of holders, of securities or warrants of the corporation; and

(f) an order approving the arrangement as proposed by the corporation or as amended in any manner the court may direct, subject to compliance with such terms and conditions, if any, as the court thinks fit,

and to the extent that any such order is inconsistent with this section such order shall prevail.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 182 (5).

Procedure

(6) Where a reorganization or scheme is proposed as an arrangement and involves an amendment of the articles of a corporation or the taking of any other steps that could be made or taken under any other provision of this Act, the procedure provided for in this section, and not the procedure provided for in such other provision, applies to such reorganization or scheme.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 182 (6).

(7) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (23).

Articles of arrangement sent to Director

183. (1) After an order referred to in clause 182 (5) (f) has been made, articles of arrangement in prescribed form shall be sent to the Director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 183 (1).

Certificate of arrangement

(2) Upon receipt of articles of arrangement the Director shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of arrangement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 183 (2).

Borrowing powers

184. (1) Unless the articles or by-laws of or a unanimous shareholder agreement otherwise provide, the articles of a corporation shall be deemed to state that the directors of a corporation may, without authorization of the shareholders,

(a) borrow money upon the credit of the corporation;

(b) issue, reissue, sell or pledge debt obligations of the corporation;

(c) subject to section 20, give a guarantee on behalf of the corporation to secure performance of an obligation of any person; and

(d) mortgage, hypothecate, pledge or otherwise create a security interest in all or any property of the corporation, owned or subsequently acquired, to secure any obligation of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (1).

Delegation of powers

(2) Unless the articles or by-laws of or a unanimous shareholder agreement relating to a corporation otherwise provide, the directors may by resolution delegate any or all of the powers referred to in subsection (1) to a director, a committee of directors or an officer.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (2).

Sale, etc., requires approval of shareholders

(3) A sale, lease or exchange of all or substantially all the property of a corporation other than in the ordinary course of business of the corporation requires the approval of the shareholders in accordance with subsections (4) to (8).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (3).

Notice

(4) The notice of a meeting of shareholders to approve a transaction referred to in subsection (3) shall be sent to all shareholders and shall include or be accompanied by,

(a) a copy or summary of the agreement of sale, lease or exchange; and

(b) a statement that a dissenting shareholder is entitled to be paid the fair value of the shares in accordance with section 185, but failure to make that statement does not invalidate a sale, lease or exchange referred to in subsection (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (4); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 25.

Shareholders may authorize sale, etc.

(5) At the meeting referred to in subsection (4), the shareholders may authorize the sale, lease or exchange and may fix or authorize the directors to fix any of the terms and conditions thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (5).

Right to vote separately

(6) If a sale, lease or exchange by a corporation referred to in subsection (3) would affect a particular class or series of shares of the corporation in a manner different from the shares of another class or series of the corporation entitled to vote on the sale, lease or exchange at the meeting referred to in subsection (4), the holders of such first mentioned class or series of shares, whether or not they are otherwise entitled to vote, are entitled to vote separately as a class or series in respect to such sale, lease or exchange.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (6).

When approval effective

(7) The approval of a sale, lease or exchange referred to in subsection (3) is effective when the shareholders have approved the sale, lease or exchange by a special resolution of the holders of the shares of each class or series entitled to vote thereon.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (7).

Approval by directors

(8) The directors of a corporation may, if authorized by the shareholders approving a proposed sale, lease or exchange, and subject to the rights of third parties, abandon the sale, lease or exchange without further approval of the shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 184 (8).

Rights of dissenting shareholders

185. (1) Subject to subsection (3) and to sections 186 and 248, if a corporation resolves to,

(a) amend its articles under section 168 to add, remove or change restrictions on the issue, transfer or ownership of shares of a class or series of the shares of the corporation;

(b) amend its articles under section 168 to add, remove or change any restriction upon the business or businesses that the corporation may carry on or upon the powers that the corporation may exercise;

(c) amalgamate with another corporation under sections 175 and 176;

(d) be continued under the laws of another jurisdiction under section 181; or

(e) sell, lease or exchange all or substantially all its property under subsection 184 (3),

a holder of shares of any class or series entitled to vote on the resolution may dissent.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (1).

Idem

(2) If a corporation resolves to amend its articles in a manner referred to in subsection 170 (1), a holder of shares of any class or series entitled to vote on the amendment under section 168 or 170 may dissent, except in respect of an amendment referred to in,

(a) clause 170 (1) (a), (b) or (e) where the articles provide that the holders of shares of such class or series are not entitled to dissent; or

(b) subsection 170 (5) or (6).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (2).

Exception

(3) A shareholder of a corporation incorporated before the 29th day of July, 1983 is not entitled to dissent under this section in respect of an amendment of the articles of the corporation to the extent that the amendment,

(a) amends the express terms of any provision of the articles of the corporation to conform to the terms of the provision as deemed to be amended by section 277; or

(b) deletes from the articles of the corporation all of the objects of the corporation set out in its articles, provided that the deletion is made by the 29th day of July, 1986.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (3).

Shareholder’s right to be paid fair value

(4) In addition to any other right the shareholder may have, but subject to subsection (30), a shareholder who complies with this section is entitled, when the action approved by the resolution from which the shareholder dissents becomes effective, to be paid by the corporation the fair value of the shares held by the shareholder in respect of which the shareholder dissents, determined as of the close of business on the day before the resolution was adopted.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (4).

No partial dissent

(5) A dissenting shareholder may only claim under this section with respect to all the shares of a class held by the dissenting shareholder on behalf of any one beneficial owner and registered in the name of the dissenting shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (5).

Objection

(6) A dissenting shareholder shall send to the corporation, at or before any meeting of shareholders at which a resolution referred to in subsection (1) or (2) is to be voted on, a written objection to the resolution, unless the corporation did not give notice to the shareholder of the purpose of the meeting or of the shareholder’s right to dissent.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (6).

Idem

(7) The execution or exercise of a proxy does not constitute a written objection for purposes of subsection (6).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (7).

Notice of adoption of resolution

(8) The corporation shall, within ten days after the shareholders adopt the resolution, send to each shareholder who has filed the objection referred to in subsection (6) notice that the resolution has been adopted, but such notice is not required to be sent to any shareholder who voted for the resolution or who has withdrawn the objection.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (8).

Idem

(9) A notice sent under subsection (8) shall set out the rights of the dissenting shareholder and the procedures to be followed to exercise those rights.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (9).

Demand for payment of fair value

(10) A dissenting shareholder entitled to receive notice under subsection (8) shall, within twenty days after receiving such notice, or, if the shareholder does not receive such notice, within twenty days after learning that the resolution has been adopted, send to the corporation a written notice containing,

(a) the shareholder’s name and address;

(b) the number and class of shares in respect of which the shareholder dissents; and

(c) a demand for payment of the fair value of such shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (10).

Certificates to be sent in

(11) Not later than the thirtieth day after the sending of a notice under subsection (10), a dissenting shareholder shall send the certificates representing the shares in respect of which the shareholder dissents to the corporation or its transfer agent.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (11).

Idem

(12) A dissenting shareholder who fails to comply with subsections (6), (10) and (11) has no right to make a claim under this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (12).

Endorsement on certificate

(13) A corporation or its transfer agent shall endorse on any share certificate received under subsection (11) a notice that the holder is a dissenting shareholder under this section and shall return forthwith the share certificates to the dissenting shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (13).

Rights of dissenting shareholder

(14) On sending a notice under subsection (10), a dissenting shareholder ceases to have any rights as a shareholder other than the right to be paid the fair value of the shares as determined under this section except where,

(a) the dissenting shareholder withdraws notice before the corporation makes an offer under subsection (15);

(b) the corporation fails to make an offer in accordance with subsection (15) and the dissenting shareholder withdraws notice; or

(c) the directors revoke a resolution to amend the articles under subsection 168 (3), terminate an amalgamation agreement under subsection 176 (5) or an application for continuance under subsection 181 (5), or abandon a sale, lease or exchange under subsection 184 (8),

in which case the dissenting shareholder’s rights are reinstated as of the date the dissenting shareholder sent the notice referred to in subsection (10), and the dissenting shareholder is entitled, upon presentation and surrender to the corporation or its transfer agent of any certificate representing the shares that has been endorsed in accordance with subsection (13), to be issued a new certificate representing the same number of shares as the certificate so presented, without payment of any fee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (14).

Offer to pay

(15) A corporation shall, not later than seven days after the later of the day on which the action approved by the resolution is effective or the day the corporation received the notice referred to in subsection (10), send to each dissenting shareholder who has sent such notice,

(a) a written offer to pay for the dissenting shareholder’s shares in an amount considered by the directors of the corporation to be the fair value thereof, accompanied by a statement showing how the fair value was determined; or

(b) if subsection (30) applies, a notification that it is unable lawfully to pay dissenting shareholders for their shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (15).

Idem

(16) Every offer made under subsection (15) for shares of the same class or series shall be on the same terms.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (16).

Idem

(17) Subject to subsection (30), a corporation shall pay for the shares of a dissenting shareholder within ten days after an offer made under subsection (15) has been accepted, but any such offer lapses if the corporation does not receive an acceptance thereof within thirty days after the offer has been made.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (17).

Application to court to fix fair value

(18) Where a corporation fails to make an offer under subsection (15) or if a dissenting shareholder fails to accept an offer, the corporation may, within fifty days after the action approved by the resolution is effective or within such further period as the court may allow, apply to the court to fix a fair value for the shares of any dissenting shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (18).

Idem

(19) If a corporation fails to apply to the court under subsection (18), a dissenting shareholder may apply to the court for the same purpose within a further period of twenty days or within such further period as the court may allow.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (19).

Idem

(20) A dissenting shareholder is not required to give security for costs in an application made under subsection (18) or (19).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (20).

Costs

(21) If a corporation fails to comply with subsection (15), then the costs of a shareholder application under subsection (19) are to be borne by the corporation unless the court otherwise orders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (21).

Notice to shareholders

(22) Before making application to the court under subsection (18) or not later than seven days after receiving notice of an application to the court under subsection (19), as the case may be, a corporation shall give notice to each dissenting shareholder who, at the date upon which the notice is given,

(a) has sent to the corporation the notice referred to in subsection (10); and

(b) has not accepted an offer made by the corporation under subsection (15), if such an offer was made,

of the date, place and consequences of the application and of the dissenting shareholder’s right to appear and be heard in person or by counsel, and a similar notice shall be given to each dissenting shareholder who, after the date of such first mentioned notice and before termination of the proceedings commenced by the application, satisfies the conditions set out in clauses (a) and (b) within three days after the dissenting shareholder satisfies such conditions.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (22).

Parties joined

(23) All dissenting shareholders who satisfy the conditions set out in clauses (22) (a) and (b) shall be deemed to be joined as parties to an application under subsection (18) or (19) on the later of the date upon which the application is brought and the date upon which they satisfy the conditions, and shall be bound by the decision rendered by the court in the proceedings commenced by the application.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (23).

Idem

(24) Upon an application to the court under subsection (18) or (19), the court may determine whether any other person is a dissenting shareholder who should be joined as a party, and the court shall fix a fair value for the shares of all dissenting shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (24).

Appraisers

(25) The court may in its discretion appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court to fix a fair value for the shares of the dissenting shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (25).

Final order

(26) The final order of the court in the proceedings commenced by an application under subsection (18) or (19) shall be rendered against the corporation and in favour of each dissenting shareholder who, whether before or after the date of the order, complies with the conditions set out in clauses (22) (a) and (b).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (26).

Interest

(27) The court may in its discretion allow a reasonable rate of interest on the amount payable to each dissenting shareholder from the date the action approved by the resolution is effective until the date of payment.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (27).

Where corporation unable to pay

(28) Where subsection (30) applies, the corporation shall, within ten days after the pronouncement of an order under subsection (26), notify each dissenting shareholder that it is unable lawfully to pay dissenting shareholders for their shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (28).

Idem

(29) Where subsection (30) applies, a dissenting shareholder, by written notice sent to the corporation within thirty days after receiving a notice under subsection (28), may,

(a) withdraw a notice of dissent, in which case the corporation is deemed to consent to the withdrawal and the shareholder’s full rights are reinstated; or

(b) retain a status as a claimant against the corporation, to be paid as soon as the corporation is lawfully able to do so or, in a liquidation, to be ranked subordinate to the rights of creditors of the corporation but in priority to its shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (29).

Idem

(30) A corporation shall not make a payment to a dissenting shareholder under this section if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the payment, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 185 (30).

Court order

(31) Upon application by a corporation that proposes to take any of the actions referred to in subsection (1) or (2), the court may, if satisfied that the proposed action is not in all the circumstances one that should give rise to the rights arising under subsection (4), by order declare that those rights will not arise upon the taking of the proposed action, and the order may be subject to compliance upon such terms and conditions as the court thinks fit and, if the corporation is an offering corporation, notice of any such application and a copy of any order made by the court upon such application shall be served upon the Commission.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (24).

Commission may appear

(32) The Commission may appoint counsel to assist the court upon the hearing of an application under subsection (31), if the corporation is an offering corporation.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (24).

Reorganization

186. (1) In this section,

“reorganization” means a court order made under section 248, an order made under the Bankruptcy and Insolvency Act (Canada) or an order made under the Companies Creditors Arrangement Act (Canada) approving a proposal.  2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (9).

Articles amended

(2) If a corporation is subject to a reorganization, its articles may be amended by the order to effect any change that might lawfully be made by an amendment under section 168.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 186 (2).

Auxiliary powers of court

(3) Where a reorganization is made, the court making the order may also,

(a) authorize the issue of debt obligations of the corporation, whether or not convertible into shares of any class or having attached any rights or options to acquire shares of any class, and fix the terms thereof; and

(b) appoint directors in place of or in addition to all or any of the directors then in office.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 186 (3).

Articles of reorganization

(4) After a reorganization has been made, articles of reorganization in prescribed form shall be sent to the Director.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 186 (4).

Certificate

(5) Upon receipt of articles of reorganization, the Director shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of amendment and the articles are amended accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 186 (5).

No dissent

(6) A shareholder is not entitled to dissent under section 185 if an amendment to the articles is effected under this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 186 (6).

PART XV
COMPULSORY ACQUISITIONS

Application and definitions

187. (1) This Part applies only to an offering corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 187 (1).

Definitions

(2) In this Part,

“dissenting offeree” means a person to whom a take-over bid or issuer bid is made who does not accept the take-over bid or issuer bid and includes a person who subsequently acquires a security that is the subject of the bid; (“pollicité dissident”)

“equity security” means any security other than a debt obligation of a corporation; (“titre de participation”)

“issuer bid” means an offer made by a corporation to security holders to purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire any or all of a class of the securities of the corporation, other than where,

(a) the securities to be purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired are debt securities that are not convertible into equity securities,

(b) the securities are to be purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired in accordance with the terms and conditions thereof or otherwise agreed to at the time they were issued or subsequently varied by amendment of the documents setting out those terms and conditions, or are acquired to meet sinking fund requirements or from an employee or a former employee of the issuer or of an affiliate, or

(c) the purchases, redemptions or other acquisitions to be made are required by the instrument creating or governing the class of securities or by this Act; (“offre de l’émetteur”)

“offeree” means a person to whom a take-over bid or an issuer bid is made; (“pollicité”)

“offeree corporation” means a corporation whose securities are the subject of a take-over bid; (“société pollicitée”)

“offeror” means a person, other than an agent, who makes a take-over bid or an issuer bid; (“pollicitant”)

“take-over bid” means an offer made to security holders of an offeree corporation to purchase directly or indirectly voting securities of the offeree corporation, where the voting securities that are the subject of the offer to purchase, the acceptance of the offer to sell or the combination thereof, as the case may be, together with the securities currently owned by the offeror, its affiliates and associates will carry, in the aggregate, 10 per cent or more of the voting rights attached to the voting securities of the offeree corporation that would be outstanding on exercise of all currently exercisable rights of purchase, conversion or exchange relating to voting securities of the offeree corporation; (“offre d’achat visant à la mainmise”)

“voting security” includes,

(a) a security currently convertible into a voting security or into another security that is convertible into a voting security,

(b) a currently exercisable option or right to acquire a voting security or another security that is convertible into a voting security, or

(c) a security carrying an option or right referred to in clause (b). (“valeur mobilière avec droit de vote”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 187 (2).

Take-over or issuer bid

188. (1) If within 120 days after the date of a take-over bid or an issuer bid, the bid is accepted by the holders of not less than 90 per cent of the securities of any class of securities to which the bid relates, other than securities held at the date of the bid by or on behalf of the offeror, or an affiliate or associate of the offeror, the offeror is entitled, upon complying with this section, to acquire the securities held by dissenting offerees.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (1).

Shares of dissenting offeree

(2) An offeror may acquire the securities of any class to which the bid relates that are held by a dissenting offeree by sending, on or before the earlier of the sixtieth day following the termination of the bid and the one hundred and eightieth day following the date of the bid, an offeror’s notice to each dissenting offeree stating in substance that,

(a) offerees holding more than 90 per cent of the securities to which the bid relates other than securities held at the date of the bid by or on behalf of the offeror or an affiliate or associate of the offeror have accepted the bid;

(b) the offeror is bound to take up and pay for or has taken up and paid for the securities of the offerees who accepted the bid;

(c) a dissenting offeree is required to elect,

(i) to transfer his, her or its securities to the offeror on the terms on which the offeror acquired the securities of the offerees who accepted the bid, or

(ii) to demand payment of the fair value of his, her or its securities in accordance with subsections (13) to (21) by notifying the offeror within twenty days after receipt of the offeror’s notice;

(d) a dissenting offeree who does not notify the offeror in accordance with subclause (c) (ii) is deemed to have elected to transfer his, her or its securities to the offeror on the same terms that the offeror acquired the securities from the offerees who accepted the bid; and

(e) a dissenting offeree must send the certificates representing his, her or its securities to which the bid relates to the offeree corporation or, in the case of an issuer bid, to the offeror within twenty days after the dissenting offeree receives the offeror’s notice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (2); 2000, c. 26, Sched. B, s. 3 (10).

Notice

(3) In the case of,

(a) a take-over bid, concurrently with sending the offeror’s notice under subsection (2), the offeror shall send or deliver to the offeree corporation a notice of adverse claim in accordance with section 88 with respect to each share held by a dissenting offeree; or

(b) an issuer bid, the offeror shall be deemed to have notice of an adverse claim for the purpose of section 88 with respect to each share held by a dissenting offeree.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (3).

Sending in share certificates

(4) A dissenting offeree to whom an offeror’s notice is sent under subsection (2) shall, within twenty days after receiving that notice,

(a) send the certificates representing his, her or its securities to which the take-over bid relates to the offeree corporation; or

(b) send the certificates representing his, her or its securities to which the issuer bid relates to the offeror.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (4).

Payment by offeror

(5) Within twenty days after the offeror sends an offeror’s notice under subsection (2), the offeror shall pay or transfer to the offeree corporation the amount of money or other consideration that the offeror would have had to pay or transfer to all dissenting offerees if they had elected to accept the take-over bid under subclause (2) (c) (i).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (5).

Trust funds

(6) An offeree corporation is deemed to hold in trust for dissenting offerees the money or other consideration it receives under subsection (5), and the offeree corporation shall deposit the money in a separate account in a bank or other body corporate any of whose deposits are insured by the Canada Deposit Insurance Corporation and shall place the other consideration in the custody of a bank or other such body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (6).

Idem

(7) The offeror making an issuer bid is deemed to hold in trust for dissenting offerees the money or other consideration that the offeror would have had to pay or transfer to all dissenting offerees if they had elected to accept the issuer bid under subclause (2) (c) (i) and, within twenty days after the issuer sends an offeror’s notice under subsection (2), the issuer shall deposit any such money in a separate account in a bank or other body corporate any of whose deposits are insured by the Canada Deposit Insurance Corporation and shall place the other consideration in the custody of a bank or such other body corporate within twenty days after the offeror sends an offeror’s notice under subsection (2).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (7).

Notice of compliance

(8) Within ten days after the offeror complies with subsection (5) or subsection (7), as the case may be, the offeror shall give notice of the date of such compliance to all dissenting offerees.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (8).

Application to court

(9) At any time prior to the thirtieth day following the day upon which the offeror’s notice referred to in subsection (2) is sent to dissenting offerees, a dissenting offeree who has demanded payment of the fair value of his, her or its securities in accordance with subclause (2) (c) (ii) may apply to the court for an order requiring the person who has sent the offeror’s notice to provide, in such form as the court considers appropriate, such additional security for payment to dissenting offerees of the fair value of their securities as the court may determine to be necessary, pending the determination of such fair value.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (9).

Where shares deemed acquired

(10) The securities of all dissenting offerees shall be deemed to have been acquired by the offeror,

(a) where an application under subsection (9) has not been made within the time set out in subsection (9), upon the expiration of that time; or

(b) where an application has been made under subsection (9), upon compliance with the order made in respect of the application.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (10).

Duties of offeree corporation

(11) Within ten days after the acquisition of the securities of dissenting offerees under subsection (10) by an offeror who has made a take-over bid, the offeree corporation shall,

(a) issue to the offeror a security certificate in respect of the securities that were held by dissenting offerees;

(b) send to each dissenting offeree who elects to accept the take-over bid terms under subclause (2) (c) (i) and who sends his, her or its security certificates as required under clause (4) (a), the money or other consideration to which the dissenting offeree is entitled; and

(c) send to each dissenting offeree who has not sent his, her or its security certificates as required under clause (4) (a), notice stating in substance that,

(i) the certificates representing the dissenting offeree’s securities have been cancelled,

(ii) the offeree corporation or some designated person holds in trust for the dissenting offeree the money or other consideration to which the dissenting offeree is entitled as payment for or in exchange for his, her or its securities, and

(iii) the offeree corporation will, subject to subsections (13) to (21), send that money or other consideration to the dissenting offeree forthwith after receiving his, her or its securities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (11).

Payment by offeror

(12) Within ten days after the acquisition of the securities of dissenting offerees under subsection (10) by an offeror who has made an issuer bid, the offeror shall,

(a) send to each dissenting offeree who elects to accept the issuer bid terms under subclause (2) (c) (i) and who sends his, her or its security certificates as required under clause (4) (b), the money or other consideration to which the dissenting offeree is entitled; and

(b) send to each dissenting offeree who has not sent his, her or its security certificates as required under clause (4) (b) a notice stating in substance that,

(i) the certificates representing the dissenting offeree’s securities have been cancelled,

(ii) the offeror or some designated person holds in trust for the dissenting offeree the money or other consideration to which the dissenting offeree is entitled as payment for or in exchange for his, her or its securities, and

(iii) the offeror will, subject to subsections (13) to (21), send that money or other consideration to the dissenting offeree forthwith after receiving his, her or its securities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (12).

Application to fix fair value

(13) If a dissenting offeree has elected to demand payment of the fair value of his, her or its securities under subclause (2) (c) (ii), the offeror may, in the case of a take-over bid, within twenty days after it has complied with subsection (5) or, in the case of an issuer bid, within twenty days after it has complied with subsection (7), apply to the court to fix the fair value of the securities of that dissenting offeree.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (13).

Idem

(14) If an offeror fails to apply to the court under subsection (13), a dissenting offeree may apply to the court for the same purpose within a further period of twenty days.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (14).

Where no application

(15) If no application is made to the court under subsection (13) or (14) within the periods set out in those subsections, a dissenting offeree is deemed to have elected to transfer his, her or its securities to the offeror on the same terms that the offeror acquired the securities from offerees who accepted the take-over or issuer bid and, provided that the dissenting offeree has complied with subsection (4), the issuer or the offeree corporation, as the case may be, shall pay or transfer to the dissenting offeree the money or other consideration to which the dissenting offeree is entitled.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (15).

Security for costs not required

(16) A dissenting offeree is not required to give security for costs in an application made under subsection (13) or (14).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (16).

Parties

(17) Upon an application under subsection (13) or (14),

(a) all dissenting offerees referred to in subclause (2) (c) (ii) whose securities have not been acquired by the offeror shall be joined as parties and are bound by the decision of the court; and

(b) the offeror shall notify each such dissenting offeree of the date, place and consequences of the application and of the dissenting offeree’s right to appear and be heard in person or by counsel.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (17).

Idem

(18) Upon an application to the court under subsection (13) or (14), the court may determine whether any other person is a dissenting offeree who should be joined as a party, and the court shall then fix a fair value for the securities of all dissenting offerees.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (18).

Appointment of appraisers

(19) The court may appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court in fixing a fair value for the securities of each dissenting offeree.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (19).

Final order

(20) The final order of the court shall be made against the offeror in favour of each dissenting offeree.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (20).

What court may order

(21) In connection with proceedings under this section, the court may make any order it thinks fit and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, it may,

(a) fix the amount of money or other consideration that is required to be held in trust under subsection (6) or (7);

(b) order that the money or other consideration be held in trust by a person other than,

(i) the offeree corporation, or

(ii) in the case of an issuer bid, the offeror corporation;

(c) allow a reasonable rate of interest on the amount payable to each dissenting offeree from the date the dissenting offeree sends his, her or its security certificates under subsection (4) until the date of payment; or

(d) order that any money payable to a dissenting offeree who cannot be found be paid to the Public Trustee.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 188 (21).

Where corporation required to acquire securities

189. (1) Where 90 per cent or more of a class of securities of a corporation, other than debt obligations, are acquired by or on behalf of a person, the person’s affiliates and the person’s associates, then the holder of any securities of that class not counted for the purposes of calculating such percentage shall be entitled in accordance with this section to require the corporation to acquire the holder’s securities of that class.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (1).

Notice

(2) Every corporation, within thirty days after it becomes aware that security holders are entitled to require it to acquire their securities under subsection (1), shall send a written notice to each such security holder that the security holder may within sixty days after the date of such notice require the corporation to acquire his, her or its securities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (2).

Idem

(3) The notice sent by the corporation under subsection (2) shall,

(a) set out a price that the corporation is willing to pay for the securities;

(b) give the basis for arriving at the price;

(c) state the location where any supporting material used for arriving at the price may be examined and extracts taken therefrom by the security holder or a duly authorized agent; and

(d) state that if the security holder is not satisfied with the price offered by the corporation in the notice, the security holder is entitled to have the fair value of his, her or its securities fixed by the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (3).

Election by security holder

(4) Where a security holder receives a notice under subsection (2) and wishes the corporation to acquire his, her or its securities, the security holder may, within sixty days after the date of the notice,

(a) elect to accept the price offered by the corporation by giving notice of acceptance to the corporation and by forthwith sending his, her or its security certificates to the corporation; or

(b) notify the corporation that the security holder wishes to have the fair value of his, her or its securities fixed by the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (4).

Application to fix fair value

(5) Where a security holder wishes to have the fair value of his, her or its securities fixed by the court, the corporation shall make an application to the court within ninety days after the date of the notice under subsection (2).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (5).

Idem

(6) If a corporation fails to send notice under subsection (2), a security holder, after giving the corporation thirty days notice of intention so to do, may apply to the court to have the fair value of his, her or its securities fixed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (6).

Idem

(7) If a corporation fails to make an application to the court as required under subsection (5), a security holder may make the application.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (7).

Parties

(8) Upon an application to the court under subsection (5), (6) or (7),

(a) all security holders who have notified the corporation under clause (4) (b) may be joined as parties as the court thinks fit and, if so joined, are bound by the decision of the court; and

(b) the corporation shall notify each security holder entitled to notice under subsection (2) of the date, place and purpose of the application and of the security holder’s right to appear and be heard in person or by counsel.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (8).

Idem

(9) Upon an application to the court under subsection (5), (6) or (7), the court may determine whether any security holders should properly be sent or have been sent notice and whether such security holders should be joined as parties.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (9).

Appointment of appraiser

(10) The court may appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court in fixing a fair value for the securities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (10).

Final order

(11) The final order of the court shall be made against the corporation in favour of each entitled security holder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (11).

Security not required

(12) A security holder requesting the court to fix the fair value of his, her or its securities is not required to give security for costs on the application.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (12).

Costs

(13) The costs under this section shall be on a solicitor and client basis.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 189 (13).

Going private transaction

190. (1) In this section,

“affected security” means a participating security of a corporation in which the interest of the holder would be terminated by reason of a going private transaction; (“valeur mobilière visée”)

“going private transaction” means an amalgamation, arrangement, consolidation or other transaction carried out under this Act by a corporation that would cause the interest of a holder of a participating security of the corporation to be terminated without the consent of the holder and without the substitution therefor of an interest of equivalent value in a participating security that,

(a) is issued by the corporation, an affiliate of the corporation or a successor body corporate, and

(b) is not limited in the extent of its participation in earnings to any greater extent than the participating security for which it is substituted,

but does not include,

(c) an acquisition under section 188,

(d) a redemption of, or other compulsory termination of the interest of the holder in, a security if the security is redeemed or otherwise acquired in accordance with the terms and conditions attaching thereto or under a requirement of the articles relating to the class of securities or of this Act, or

(e) a proceeding under Part XVI; (“transformation en société fermée”)

“participating security” means a security issued by a body corporate other than a security that is, in all circumstances, limited in the extent of its participation in earnings and includes,

(a) a security currently convertible into such a security, and

(b) currently exercisable warrants entitling the holder to acquire such a security or such a convertible security. (“valeur mobilière participante”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (1).

Valuation

(2) A corporation that proposes to carry out a going private transaction shall have prepared by an independent, qualified valuer a written valuation indicating a per security value or range of values for each class of affected securities, and,

(a) the valuation shall be prepared or revised as of a date not more than 120 days before the announcement of the going private transaction, with appropriate adjustments for subsequent events other than the going private transaction;

(b) the valuation shall not contain a downward adjustment to reflect the fact that the affected securities do not form part of a controlling interest; and

(c) if the consideration to be received by the holders of the affected securities is wholly or partly other than cash, or a right to receive cash within ninety days after the approval by security holders of the going private transaction, the valuation shall include the valuer’s opinion whether the value of each affected security to be surrendered is equal to or greater than the total value of the consideration to be received therefor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (2).

Information circular

(3) The corporation shall send a management information circular to the holders of the affected securities not less than forty days prior to the date of a meeting which shall be called by it to consider that transaction, and the information circular shall contain, in addition to any other required information and subject to any exemption granted under subsection (6),

(a) a summary of the valuation prepared in compliance with subsection (2) and a statement that a holder of an affected security may inspect a copy of the valuation at the registered office of the corporation or may obtain a copy of the valuation upon request and payment of a specified amount sufficient to cover reasonable costs of reproduction and mailing;

(b) a statement of the approval or approvals of holders of affected securities required to be obtained in accordance with this section;

(c) a certificate signed by a senior officer or a director of the corporation certifying that he or she and, to his or her knowledge, the corporation are unaware of any material fact relevant to the valuation prepared in compliance with subsection (2) that was not disclosed to the valuer; and

(d) a statement of the class or classes of affected securities and of the number of securities of each class and, if any securities of any such class are, under paragraph 3 of subsection (4), not to be taken into account in the vote required by subsection (4), a statement of the number thereof and why they are not to be taken into account,

but if all or any portion of a class of affected securities is represented by certificates that are not in registered form, it shall be sufficient to make the information circular available to the holders of such affected securities in the manner provided for in the terms of the securities for sending notice to such holders or otherwise in such manner as may be prescribed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (3).

Idem

(4) A corporation shall not carry out a going private transaction unless, in addition to any other required security holder approval, the transaction is approved by the holders of each class of affected securities by a vote in accordance with the following provisions:

1. If the consideration to be received by a holder of an affected security of the particular class is,

i. payable wholly or partly other than in cash or a right to receive cash within ninety days after the approval of the going private transaction, or

ii. payable entirely in cash and is less in amount than the per security value or the mid-point of the range of per security values, arrived at by the valuation prepared in compliance with subsection (2),

then the approval shall be given by a special resolution.

2. In cases other than those referred to in paragraph 1, the approval shall be given by an ordinary resolution.

3. In determining whether the transaction has been approved by the requisite majority, the votes of,

i. securities held by affiliates of the corporation,

ii. securities the beneficial owners of which will, consequent upon the going private transaction, be entitled to a per security consideration greater than that available to other holders of affected securities of the same class,

iii. securities the beneficial owners of which, alone or in concert with others, effectively control the corporation and who, prior to distribution of the information circular, entered into an understanding that they would support the going private transaction,

shall be disregarded both in determining the total number of votes cast and in determining the number of votes cast in favour of or against the transaction.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (4).

Effect of section

(5) The rights provided by this section are in addition to any other rights of a holder of affected securities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (5).

Powers of Commission

(6) Upon an application by an interested person, the Commission may, subject to such terms and conditions as it may impose, exempt any person from any requirement of this section where in its opinion to do so would not be prejudicial to the public interest, and the Commission may publish guidelines as to the manner and circumstances in which it will exercise this discretion.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (6).

Rights of security holder

(7) A holder of an affected security that is a share of any class of a corporation may dissent from a going private transaction upon compliance with the procedures set out in section 185, in which case the holder shall be entitled to the rights and remedies provided by that section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 190 (7).

PART XVI
LIQUIDATION AND DISSOLUTION

Definition

191. In sections 193 to 236,

“contributory” means a person who is liable to contribute to the property of a corporation in the event of the corporation being wound up under this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 191.

Application of ss. 193-205

192. Sections 193 to 205 apply to corporations being wound up voluntarily.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 192.

Voluntary winding up

193. (1) The shareholders of a corporation may, by special resolution, require the corporation to be wound up voluntarily.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 193 (1).

Appointment of liquidator

(2) At such meeting, the shareholders shall appoint one or more persons, who may be directors, officers or employees of the corporation, as liquidator of the estate and effects of the corporation for the purpose of winding up its business and affairs and distributing its property, and may at that or any subsequent meeting fix the liquidator’s remuneration and the costs, charges and expenses of the winding up.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 193 (2).

Review of remuneration by court

(3) On the application of any shareholder or creditor of the corporation or of the liquidator, the court may review the remuneration of the liquidator and, whether or not the remuneration has been fixed in accordance with subsection (2), the court may fix and determine the remuneration at such amount as it thinks proper.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 193 (3).

Publication of notice

(4) A corporation shall file notice, in the prescribed form, of a resolution requiring the voluntary winding up of the corporation with the Director within ten days after the resolution has been passed and shall publish the notice in The Ontario Gazette within twenty days after the resolution has been passed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 193 (4).

Inspectors

194. The shareholders of a corporation being wound up voluntarily may delegate to any committee of shareholders, contributories or creditors, hereinafter referred to as inspectors, the power of appointing the liquidator and filling any vacancy in the office of liquidator, or may enter into any arrangement with creditors of the corporation with respect to the powers to be exercised by the liquidator and the manner in which they are to be exercised.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 194.

Vacancy in office of liquidator

195. If a vacancy occurs in the office of liquidator by death, resignation or otherwise, the shareholders may, subject to any arrangement the corporation may have entered into with its creditors upon the appointment of inspectors, fill such vacancy, and a meeting for that purpose may be called by the continuing liquidator, if any, or by any shareholder or contributory, and shall be deemed to have been duly held if called in the manner prescribed by the articles or by-laws of the corporation, or, in default thereof, in the manner prescribed by this Act for calling meetings of the shareholders of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 195.

Removal of liquidator

196. The shareholders of a corporation may by ordinary resolution passed at a meeting called for that purpose remove a liquidator appointed under section 193, 194 or 195, and in such case shall appoint a replacement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 196.

Commencement of winding up

197. A voluntary winding up commences at the time of the passing of the resolution requiring the winding up or at such later time as may be specified in the resolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 197.

Corporation to cease business

198. A corporation being wound up voluntarily shall, from the commencement of its winding up, cease to carry on its undertaking, except in so far as may be required as beneficial for the winding up thereof, and all transfers of shares, except transfers made to or with the sanction of the liquidator taking place after the commencement of its winding up, are void, but its corporate existence and all its corporate powers, even if it is otherwise provided by its articles or by-laws, continue until its affairs are wound up.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 198.

No proceedings against corporation after voluntary winding up except by leave

199. After the commencement of a voluntary winding up,

(a) no action or other proceeding shall be commenced against the corporation; and

(b) no attachment, sequestration, distress or execution shall be put in force against the estate or effects of the corporation,

except by leave of the court and subject to such terms as the court imposes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 199.

List of contributories and calls

200. (1) Upon a voluntary winding up, the liquidator,

(a) shall settle the list of contributories; and

(b) may, before the liquidator has ascertained the sufficiency of the property of the corporation, call on all or any of the contributories for the time being settled on the list of contributories to the extent of their liability to pay any sum that the liquidator considers necessary for satisfying the liabilities of the corporation and the costs, charges and expenses of winding up and for adjusting the rights of the contributories among themselves.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 200 (1).

List is proof

(2) A list settled by the liquidator under clause (1) (a) is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, proof of the liability of the persons named therein to be contributories.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 200 (2).

Default on calls

(3) The liquidator in making a call under clause (1) (b) may take into consideration the probability that some of the contributories upon whom the call is made may partly or wholly fail to pay their respective portions of the call.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 200 (3).

Meetings of corporation during winding up

201. (1) The liquidator may, during the continuance of the voluntary winding up, call meetings of the shareholders of the corporation for any purpose the liquidator thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 201 (1).

Where winding up continues more than one year

(2) Where a voluntary winding up continues for more than one year, the liquidator shall call a meeting of the shareholders of the corporation at the end of the first year and of each succeeding year from the commencement of the winding up, and the liquidator shall lay before the meeting an account showing the liquidator’s acts and dealings and the manner in which the winding up has been conducted during the immediately preceding year.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 201 (2).

Arrangements with creditors

202. The liquidator, with the approval of the shareholders of the corporation or the inspectors, may make such compromise or other arrangement as the liquidator thinks expedient with any creditor or person claiming to be a creditor or having or alleging that he, she or it has a claim, present or future, certain or contingent, liquidated or unliquidated, against the corporation or whereby the corporation may be rendered liable.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 202.

Power to compromise with debtors and contributories

203. The liquidator may, with the approval referred to in section 202, compromise all debts and liabilities capable of resulting in debts, and all claims, whether present or future, certain or contingent, liquidated or unliquidated, subsisting or supposed to subsist between the corporation and any contributory, alleged contributory or other debtor or person who may be liable to the corporation and all questions in any way relating to or affecting the property of the corporation, or the winding up of the corporation, upon the receipt of such sums payable at such times and generally upon such terms as are agreed, and the liquidator may take any security for the discharge of such debts or liabilities and give a complete discharge in respect thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 203.

Power to accept shares, etc., as consideration for sale of property to another body corporate

204. (1) Where a corporation is proposed to be or is in the course of being wound up voluntarily and it is proposed to transfer the whole or a portion of its business or property to another body corporate, the liquidator, with the approval of a resolution of the shareholders of the corporation conferring either a general authority on the liquidator or an authority in respect of any particular arrangement, may receive, in compensation or in part-compensation for the transfer, cash or shares or other like interest in the purchasing body corporate or any other body corporate for the purpose of distribution among the creditors or shareholders of the corporation that is being wound up in the manner set forth in the arrangement, or may, in lieu of receiving cash or shares or other like interest, or in addition thereto, participate in the profits of or receive any other benefit from the purchasing body corporate or any other body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 204 (1).

Confirmation of sale or arrangement

(2) A transfer made or arrangement entered into by the liquidator under this section is not binding on the shareholders of the corporation that is being wound up unless the transfer or arrangement is approved in accordance with subsections 184 (3), (6) and (7).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 204 (2).

Where resolution not invalid

(3) No resolution is invalid for the purposes of this section because it was passed before or concurrently with a resolution for winding up the corporation or for appointing the liquidator.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 204 (3).

Account of voluntary winding up to be made by liquidator to a meeting

205. (1) The liquidator shall make up an account showing the manner in which the winding up has been conducted and the property of the corporation disposed of, and thereupon shall call a meeting of the shareholders of the corporation for the purpose of having the account laid before them and hearing any explanation that may be given by the liquidator, and the meeting shall be called in the manner prescribed by the articles or by-laws or, in default thereof, in the manner prescribed by this Act for the calling of meetings of shareholders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 205 (1).

Notice of holding of meeting

(2) The liquidator shall within ten days after the meeting is held file a notice in the prescribed form with the Director stating that the meeting was held and the date thereof and shall forthwith publish the notice in The Ontario Gazette.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 205 (2).

Dissolution

(3) Subject to subsection (4), on the expiration of three months after the date of the filing of the notice, the corporation is dissolved.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 205 (3).

Extension

(4) At any time during the three-month period mentioned in subsection (3), the court may, on the application of the liquidator or any other person interested, make an order deferring the date on which the dissolution of the corporation is to take effect to a date fixed in the order, and in such event the corporation is dissolved on the date so fixed.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 205 (4).

Dissolution by court order

(5) Despite anything in this Act, the court at any time after the affairs of the corporation have been fully wound up may, upon the application of the liquidator or any other person interested, make an order dissolving it, and it is dissolved on the date fixed in the order.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 205 (5).

Copy of extension order to be filed

(6) The person on whose application an order was made under subsection (4) or (5) shall within ten days after it was made file with the Director a certified copy of the order and forthwith publish notice of the order in The Ontario Gazette.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 205 (6).

Application of ss. 207-218

206. Sections 207 to 218 apply to corporations being wound up by order of the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 206.

Winding up by court

207. (1) A corporation may be wound up by order of the court,

(a) where the court is satisfied that in respect of the corporation or any of its affiliates,

(i) any act or omission of the corporation or any of its affiliates effects a result,

(ii) the business or affairs of the corporation or any of its affiliates are or have been carried on or conducted in a manner, or

(iii) the powers of the directors of the corporation or any of its affiliates are or have been exercised in a manner,

that is oppressive or unfairly prejudicial to or that unfairly disregards the interests of any security holder, creditor, director or officer; or

(b) where the court is satisfied that,

(i) a unanimous shareholder agreement entitled a complaining shareholder to demand dissolution of the corporation after the occurrence of a specified event and that event has occurred,

(ii) proceedings have been begun to wind up voluntarily and it is in the interest of contributories and creditors that the proceedings should be continued under the supervision of the court,

(iii) the corporation, though it may not be insolvent, cannot by reason of its liabilities continue its business and it is advisable to wind it up, or

(iv) it is just and equitable for some reason, other than the bankruptcy or insolvency of the corporation, that it should be wound up; or

(c) where the shareholders by special resolution authorize an application to be made to the court to wind up the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 207 (1).

Court order

(2) Upon an application under this section, the court may make such order under this section or section 248 as it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 207 (2).

Who may apply

208. (1) A winding-up order may be made upon the application of the corporation or of a shareholder or, where the corporation is being wound up voluntarily, of the liquidator or of a contributory or of a creditor having a claim of $2,500 or more.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 208 (1).

Notice

(2) Except where the application is made by the corporation, four days’ notice of the application shall be given to the corporation before the making of the application.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 208 (2).

Power of court

209. The court may make the order applied for, may dismiss the application with or without costs, may adjourn the hearing conditionally or unconditionally or may make any interim or other order as is considered just, and upon the making of the order may, according to its practice and procedure, refer the proceedings for the winding up to an officer of the court for inquiry and report and may authorize the officer to exercise such powers of the court as are necessary for the reference.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 209.

Appointment of liquidator

210. (1) The court in making the winding-up order may appoint one or more persons as liquidator of the estate and effects of the corporation for the purpose of winding up its business and affairs and distributing its property.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 210 (1).

Remuneration

(2) The court may at any time fix the remuneration of the liquidator.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 210 (2).

Vacancy

(3) If a liquidator appointed by the court dies or resigns or the office becomes vacant for any reason, the court may by order fill the vacancy.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 210 (3).

Notice of appointment

(4) A liquidator appointed by the court under this section shall forthwith give to the Director notice in the prescribed form of the liquidator’s appointment and shall, within twenty days after being appointed publish the notice in The Ontario Gazette.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 210 (4).

Removal of liquidator

211. The court may by order remove for cause a liquidator appointed by it, and in such case shall appoint a replacement.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 211.

Costs and expenses

212. The costs, charges and expenses of a winding up by order of the court shall be assessed by an assessment officer of the Superior Court of Justice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 212; 2001, c. 9, Sched. D, s. 2 (4).

Commencement of winding up

213. Where a winding-up order is made by the court without prior voluntary winding-up proceedings, the winding up shall, unless a court otherwise orders, be deemed to commence at the time of the service of notice of the application, and, where the application is made by the corporation, at the time the application is made.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 213.

Proceedings in winding up after order

214. Where a winding-up order has been made by the court, proceedings for the winding up of the corporation shall be taken in the same manner and with the like consequences as provided for a voluntary winding up, except that the list of contributories shall be settled by the court unless it has been settled by the liquidator before the winding-up order, in which case the list is subject to review by the court, and except that all proceedings in the winding up are subject to the order and direction of the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 214.

Orders following winding-up order

Meetings of shareholders

215. (1) Where a winding-up order has been made by the court, the court may direct meetings of the shareholders of the corporation to be called, held and conducted in such manner as the court thinks fit for the purpose of ascertaining their wishes, and may appoint a person to act as chair of any such meeting and to report the result of it to the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 215 (1).

Order for delivery by contributories and others of property, etc.

(2) Where a winding-up order has been made by the court, the court may require any contributory for the time being settled on the list of contributories, or any director, officer, employee, trustee, banker or agent of the corporation to pay, deliver, convey, surrender or transfer forthwith, or within such time as the court directs, to the liquidator any sum or balance, documents, records, estate or effects that are in his, her or its hands and to which the corporation is apparently entitled.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 215 (2).

Inspection of documents and records

(3) Where a winding-up order has been made by the court, the court may make an order for the inspection of the documents and records of the corporation by its creditors and contributories, and any documents and records in the possession of the corporation may be inspected in conformity with the order.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 215 (3).

Proceedings against corporation after court winding up

216. After the commencement of a winding up by order of the court,

(a) no action or other proceeding shall be proceeded with or commenced against the corporation; and

(b) no attachment, sequestration, distress or execution shall be put in force against the estate or effects of the corporation,

except by leave of the court and subject to such terms as the court imposes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 216.

Provision for discharge and distribution by the court

217. (1) Where the realization and distribution of the property of a corporation being wound up under an order of the court has proceeded so far that in the opinion of the court it is expedient that the liquidator should be discharged and that the property of the corporation remaining in the liquidator’s hands can be better realized and distributed by the court, the court may make an order discharging the liquidator and for payment, delivery and transfer into court, or to such person as the court directs, of such property, and it shall be realized and distributed by or under the direction of the court among the persons entitled thereto in the same way as nearly as may be as if the distribution were being made by the liquidator.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 217 (1).

Disposal of documents and records

(2) In such case, the court may make an order directing how the documents and records of the corporation and of the liquidator are to be disposed of, and may order that they be deposited in court or otherwise dealt with as the court thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 217 (2).

Order for dissolution

218. (1) The court at any time after the business and affairs of the corporation have been fully wound up may, upon the application of the liquidator or any other person interested, make an order dissolving it, and it is dissolved on the date fixed in the order.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 218 (1).

Copy of dissolution order to be filed

(2) The person on whose application the order was made shall within ten days after it was made file with the Director a certified copy of the order and shall forthwith publish notice of the order in The Ontario Gazette.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 218 (2).

Application of ss. 220-236

219. Sections 220 to 236 apply to corporations being wound up voluntarily or by order of the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 219.

Where no liquidator

220. Where there is no liquidator,

(a) the court may by order on the application of a shareholder of the corporation appoint one or more persons as liquidator; and

(b) the estate and effects of the corporation shall be under the control of the court until the appointment of a liquidator.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 220.

Consequences of winding up

221. (1) Upon a winding up,

(a) the liquidator shall apply the property of the corporation in satisfaction of all its debts, obligations and liabilities and, subject thereto, shall distribute the property rateably among the shareholders according to their rights and interests in the corporation;

(b) in distributing the property of the corporation, debts to employees of the corporation for services performed for it due at the commencement of the winding up or within one month before, not exceeding three months’ wages and vacation pay accrued for not more than twelve months, shall be paid in priority to the claims of the ordinary creditors, and such persons are entitled to rank as ordinary creditors for the residue of their claims;

(c) all the powers of the directors cease upon the appointment of a liquidator, except in so far as the liquidator may sanction the continuance of such powers.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 221 (1).

Distribution of property

(2) Section 53 of the Trustee Act applies with necessary modifications to liquidators.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 221 (2).

Payment of costs and expenses

222. The costs, charges and expenses of a winding up, including the remuneration of the liquidator, are payable out of the property of the corporation in priority to all other claims.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 222.

Powers of liquidators

223. (1) A liquidator may,

(a) bring or defend any action, suit or prosecution, or other legal proceedings, civil or criminal, in the name and on behalf of the corporation;

(b) carry on the business of the corporation so far as may be required as beneficial for the winding up of the corporation;

(c) sell the property of the corporation by public auction or private sale and receive payment of the purchase price either in cash or otherwise;

(d) do all acts and execute, in the name and on behalf of the corporation, all documents, and for that purpose use the seal of the corporation, if any;

(e) draw, accept, make and endorse any bill of exchange or promissory note in the name and on behalf of the corporation;

(f) raise upon the security of the property of the corporation any requisite money;

(g) take out in the liquidator’s official name letters of administration of the estate of any deceased contributory and do in the liquidator’s official name any other act that is necessary for obtaining payment of any money due from a contributory or from the contributory’s estate and which act cannot be done conveniently in the name of the corporation; and

(h) do and execute all such other things as are necessary for winding up the business and affairs of the corporation and distributing its property.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 223 (1).

Bills of exchange, etc., to be deemed drawn in the course of business

(2) The drawing, accepting, making or endorsing of a bill of exchange or promissory note by the liquidator on behalf of a corporation has the same effect with respect to the liability of the corporation as if such bill or note had been drawn, accepted, made or endorsed by or on behalf of the corporation in the course of carrying on its business.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 223 (2).

Where money deemed to be due to liquidator

(3) Where the liquidator takes out letters of administration or otherwise uses the liquidator’s official name for obtaining payment of any money due from a contributory, such money shall be deemed, for the purpose of enabling the liquidator to take out such letters or recover such money, to be due to the liquidator rather than to the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 223 (3).

What liquidator may rely upon

(4) A liquidator who acts in good faith is entitled to rely upon,

(a) financial statements of the corporation represented to the liquidator by an officer of the corporation or in a written report of the auditor of the corporation to present fairly the financial position of the corporation in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; or

(b) an opinion, a report or a statement of a lawyer, an accountant, an engineer, an appraiser or other professional adviser retained by the liquidator.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 223 (4).

Acts by more than one liquidator

224. Where more than one person is appointed as liquidator, any power conferred by sections 193 to 236 on a liquidator may be exercised by such one or more of such persons as may be determined by the resolution or order appointing them or, in default of such determination, by any number of them not fewer than two.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 224.

Nature of liability of contributory

225. The liability of a contributory creates a debt accruing due from the contributory at the time the contributory’s liability commenced, but payable at the time or respective times when calls are made for enforcing such liability.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 225.

Liability in case of contributory’s death

226. If a contributory dies before or after having been placed on the list of contributories, the contributory’s personal representative is liable in due course of administration to contribute to the property of the corporation in discharge of the liability of the deceased contributory and shall be a contributory accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 226.

Deposit of money

227. (1) The liquidator shall deposit all money that the liquidator has belonging to the corporation and amounting to $100 or more in any bank of Canada listed in Schedule I or II to the Bank Act (Canada) or in the Province of Ontario Savings Office or in any trust corporation or loan corporation that is registered under the Loan and Trust Corporations Act or in any other depository approved by the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 227 (1).

Note: On a day to be named by proclamation of the Lieutenant Governor, subsection (1) is amended by the Statutes of Ontario, 2002, chapter 8, Schedule I, section 2 by striking out “or in the Province of Ontario Savings Office”.  See: 2002, c. 8, Sched. I, ss. 2, 24.

Approval by inspectors

(2) If inspectors have been appointed, the depository under subsection (1) shall be one approved by them.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 227 (2).

Separate deposit account to be kept; withdrawal from account

(3) Such deposit shall not be made in the name of the liquidator individually, but a separate deposit account shall be kept of the money belonging to the corporation in the liquidator’s name as liquidator of the corporation and in the name of the inspectors, if any, and such money shall be withdrawn only by order for payment signed by the liquidator and one of the inspectors, if any.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 227 (3).

Liquidator to produce bank pass-book

(4) At every meeting of the shareholders of the corporation, the liquidator shall produce a pass-book, or statement of account showing the amount of the deposits, the dates at which they were made, the amounts withdrawn and the dates of withdrawal, and mention of such production shall be made in the minutes of the meeting, and the absence of such mention is admissible in evidence as proof, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, that the pass-book or statement of account was not produced at the meeting.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 227 (4).

Idem

(5) The liquidator shall also produce the pass-book or statement of account whenever so ordered by the court upon the application of the inspectors, if any, or of a shareholder of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 227 (5).

Proving claim

228. For the purpose of proving claims, sections 23, 24 and 25 of the Assignments and Preferences Act apply with necessary modifications, except that where the word “judge” is used therein, the word “court” as used in this Act shall be substituted.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 228.

Application for direction

229. Upon the application of the liquidator or of the inspectors, if any, or of any creditors, the court, after hearing such parties as it directs to be notified or after such steps as the court prescribes have been taken, may by order give its direction in any matter arising in the winding up.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 229.

Examination of persons as to estate

230. (1) The court may at any time after the commencement of the winding up summon to appear before the court or liquidator any director, officer or employee of the corporation or any other person known or suspected of having possession of any of the estate or effects of the corporation, or alleged to be indebted to it, or any person whom the court thinks capable of giving information concerning its trade, dealings, estate or effects.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 230 (1).

Damages against delinquent directors, etc.

(2) Where in the course of the winding up it appears that a person who has taken part in the formation or promotion of the corporation or that a past or present director, officer, employee, liquidator or receiver of the corporation has misapplied or retained in that person’s own hands, or become liable or accountable for, property of the corporation, or has committed any misfeasance or breach of trust in relation to it, the court may, on the application of the liquidator or of any creditor, shareholder or contributory, examine the conduct of that person and order that person to restore the property so misapplied or retained, or for which that person has become liable or accountable, or to contribute such sum to the property of the corporation by way of compensation in respect of such misapplication, retention, misfeasance or breach of trust, or both, as the court thinks just.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 230 (2).

Proceedings by shareholders

231. (1) Where a shareholder of the corporation desires to cause any proceeding to be taken that, in the shareholder’s opinion, would be for the benefit of the corporation, and the liquidator, under the authority of the shareholders or of the inspectors, if any, refuses or neglects to take such proceeding after being required so to do, the shareholder may obtain an order of the court authorizing the shareholder to take such proceeding in the name of the liquidator or corporation, but at the shareholder’s own expense and risk, upon such terms and conditions as to indemnity to the liquidator or corporation as the court prescribes.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 231 (1).

Benefits: when for shareholders

(2) Any benefit derived from a proceeding under subsection (1) belongs exclusively to the shareholder causing the institution of the proceeding for the shareholder’s benefit and that of any other shareholder who has joined together in causing the institution of the proceeding.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 231 (2).

when for corporation

(3) If, before the order is granted, the liquidator signifies to the court the liquidator’s readiness to institute the proceeding for the benefit of the corporation, the court shall make an order prescribing the time within which the liquidator is to do so, and in that case the advantage derived from the proceeding, if instituted within such time, belongs to the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 231 (3).

Rights conferred by Act to be in addition to other powers

232. The rights conferred by this Act are in addition to any other right to institute a proceeding against any contributory, or against any debtor of the corporation, for the recovery of any sum due from such contributory or debtor or an estate thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 232.

Stay of winding up proceedings

233. At any time during a winding up, the court, upon the application of a shareholder, creditor or contributory and upon proof to its satisfaction that all proceedings in relation to the winding up ought to be stayed, may make an order staying the proceedings altogether or for a limited time on such terms and subject to such conditions as the court thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 233.

Where creditor unknown

234. (1) Where the liquidator is unable to pay all the debts of the corporation because a creditor is unknown or a creditor’s whereabouts is unknown, the liquidator may, by agreement with the Public Trustee, pay to the Public Trustee an amount equal to the amount of the debt due to the creditor to be held in trust for the creditor, and thereupon subsections 238 (5) and (6) apply thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 234 (1).

Idem

(2) A payment under subsection (1) shall be deemed to be in satisfaction of the debt for the purposes of winding up.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 234 (2).

Where shareholder unknown

235. (1) Where the liquidator is unable to distribute rateably the property of the corporation among the shareholders because a shareholder is unknown or a shareholder’s whereabouts is unknown, the share of the property of the corporation of such shareholder may, by agreement with the Public Trustee, be delivered or conveyed by the liquidator to the Public Trustee to be held in trust for the shareholder, and thereupon subsections 238 (5) and (6) apply thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 235 (1).

Idem

(2) A delivery or conveyance under subsection (1) shall be deemed to be a distribution to that shareholder of his, her or its rateable share for the purposes of the winding up.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 235 (2).

Disposal of records, etc., after winding up

236. (1) Where a corporation has been wound up under sections 192 to 235 and is about to be dissolved, its documents and records and those of the liquidator may be disposed of as it by resolution directs in case of voluntary winding up, or as the court directs in case of winding up under an order.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 236 (1).

When responsibility as to custody of records, etc., to cease

(2) After the expiration of five years after the date of the dissolution of the corporation, no responsibility rests on it or the liquidator, or anyone to whom the custody of the documents and records has been committed, by reason that the same or any of them are not forthcoming to any person claiming to be interested therein.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 236 (2).

Voluntary dissolution

237. A corporation may be dissolved upon the authorization of,

(a) a special resolution passed at a meeting of the shareholders of the corporation duly called for the purpose or, in the case of a corporation that is not an offering corporation, by such other proportion of the votes cast as the articles provide, but such other proportion shall not be less than 50 per cent of the votes of all the shareholders entitled to vote at the meeting;

(b) the consent in writing of all the shareholders entitled to vote at such meeting; or

(c) all its incorporators or their personal representatives at any time within two years after the date set out in its certificate of incorporation where the corporation has not commenced business and has not issued any shares.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 237.

Articles of dissolution where corporation active

238. (1) For the purpose of bringing the dissolution authorized under clause 237 (a) or (b) into effect, articles of dissolution shall follow the prescribed form and shall set out,

(a) the name of the corporation;

(b) that its dissolution has been duly authorized under clause 237 (a) or (b);

(c) that it has no debts, obligations or liabilities or its debts, obligations or liabilities have been duly provided for in accordance with subsection (3) or its creditors or other persons having interests in its debts, obligations or liabilities consent to its dissolution;

(d) that after satisfying the interests of creditors in all its debts, obligations and liabilities, if any, it has no property to distribute among its shareholders or that it has distributed its remaining property rateably among its shareholders according to their rights and interests in the corporation or in accordance with subsection (4) where applicable; and

(e) that there are no proceedings pending in any court against it.

(f) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (25).

R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 238 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (25).

Articles of dissolution where corporation never active

(2) For the purpose of bringing a dissolution authorized under clause 237 (c) into effect, articles of dissolution shall follow the prescribed form and shall set out,

(a) the name of the corporation;

(b) the date set out in its certificate of incorporation;

(c) that the corporation has not commenced business;

(d) that none of its shares has been issued;

(e) that dissolution has been duly authorized under clause 237 (c);

(f) that it has no debts, obligations or liabilities;

(g) that after satisfying the interests of creditors in all its debts, obligations and liabilities, if any, it has no property to distribute or that it has distributed its remaining property to the persons entitled thereto; and

(h) that there are no proceedings pending in any court against it.

(i) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (26).

R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 238 (2); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (26).

Where creditor unknown

(3) Where a corporation authorizes its dissolution and a creditor is unknown or a creditor’s whereabouts is unknown, the corporation may, by agreement with the Public Trustee, pay to the Public Trustee an amount equal to the amount of the debt due to the creditor to be held in trust for the creditor, and such payment shall be deemed to be due provision for the debt for the purposes of clause (1) (c).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 238 (3).

Where shareholder unknown

(4) Where a corporation authorizes its dissolution and a shareholder is unknown or a shareholder’s whereabouts is unknown, it may, by agreement with the Public Trustee, deliver or convey the shareholder’s share of the property to the Public Trustee to be held in trust for the shareholder, and such delivery or conveyance shall be deemed to be a distribution to that shareholder of his, her or its rateable share for the purposes of the dissolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 238 (4).

Power to convert

(5) If the share of the property so delivered or conveyed to the Public Trustee under subsection (4) is in a form other than cash, the Public Trustee may at any time, and within ten years after such delivery or conveyance shall, convert it into cash.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 238 (5).

Payment to person entitled

(6) If the amount paid under subsection (3) or the share of the property delivered or conveyed under subsection (4) or its equivalent in cash, as the case may be, is claimed by the person beneficially entitled thereto within ten years after it was so delivered, conveyed or paid, it shall be delivered, conveyed or paid to the person, but, if not so claimed, it vests in the Public Trustee for the use of Ontario, and, if the person beneficially entitled thereto at any time thereafter establishes a right thereto to the satisfaction of the Lieutenant Governor in Council, an amount equal to the amount so vested in the Public Trustee shall be paid to the person.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 238 (6).

Certificate of dissolution

239. (1) Upon receipt of the articles of dissolution, the Director shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of dissolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 239 (1).

Incorporators to sign articles of dissolution

(2) Despite clause 273 (1) (a), articles of dissolution for the purposes of subsection 238 (2) shall be signed by all its incorporators or their personal representatives.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 239 (2).

Cancellation of certificate, etc., by Director

240. (1) Where sufficient cause is shown to the Director, despite the imposition of any other penalty in respect thereof and in addition to any rights the Director may have under this or any other Act, the Director may, after having given the corporation an opportunity to be heard, by order, upon such terms and conditions as the Director thinks fit, cancel a certificate of incorporation or any other certificate issued or endorsed under this Act or a predecessor of this Act, and,

(a) in the case of the cancellation of a certificate of incorporation, the corporation is dissolved on the date fixed in the order; and

(b) in the case of the cancellation of any other certificate, the matter that became effective upon the issuance of the certificate ceases to be in effect from the date fixed in the order.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 240 (1).

Definition

(2) In this section,

“sufficient cause”, with respect to cancellation of a certificate of incorporation, includes,

(a) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (27).

(b) failure to comply with subsection 115 (2) or subsection 118 (3),

(c) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (27).

(d) a conviction of the corporation for an offence under the Criminal Code (Canada) or any other federal statute or an offence as defined in the Provincial Offences Act, in circumstances where cancellation of the certificate is in the public interest, or

(e) conduct described in subsection 248 (2).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 240 (2); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (27, 28).

Notice of dissolution

241. (1) Where the Director is notified by the Minister of Revenue that a corporation is in default in complying with the provisions of the Corporations Tax Act, the Director may give notice by registered mail to the corporation or by publication once in The Ontario Gazette that an order dissolving the corporation will be issued unless the corporation remedies its default within ninety days after the giving of the notice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 241 (1).

Idem

(2) Where the Director is notified by the Commission that a corporation has not complied with sections 77 and 78 of the Securities Act, the Director may give notice by registered mail to the corporation or by publication once in The Ontario Gazette that an order dissolving the corporation will be issued unless the corporation complies with sections 77 and 78 of the Securities Act within ninety days after the giving of the notice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 241 (2).

Same, non-filing

(3) Where a corporation fails to comply with a filing requirement under the Corporations Information Act or fails to pay a fee required under this Act, the Director may give notice in accordance with section 263 to the corporation or by publication once in The Ontario Gazette that an order dissolving the corporation will be issued unless the corporation, within 90 days after the notice is given, complies with the requirement or pays the fee.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 26 (1).

Order for dissolution

(4) Upon default in compliance with the notice given under subsection (1), (2) or (3), the Director may by order cancel the certificate of incorporation and, subject to subsection (5), the corporation is dissolved on the date fixed in the order.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 241 (4).

Revival

(5) Where a corporation is dissolved under subsection (4) or any predecessor of it, the Director on the application of any interested person, may, in his or her discretion, on the terms and conditions that the Director sees fit to impose, revive the corporation; upon revival, the corporation, subject to the terms and conditions imposed by the Director and to the rights, if any, acquired by any person during the period of dissolution, shall be deemed for all purposes to have never been dissolved.  1999, c. 12, Sched. F, s. 9.

Articles of revival

(6) The application referred to in subsection (5) shall be in the form of articles of revival which shall be in prescribed form.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 241 (6).

Certificate of revival

(7) Upon receipt of articles of revival and any other prescribed documents, the Director, subject to subsection (5), shall endorse thereon in accordance with section 273 a certificate which shall constitute the certificate of revival.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 241 (7).

Actions after dissolution

242. (1) Despite the dissolution of a corporation under this Act,

(a) a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding commenced by or against the corporation before its dissolution may be continued as if the corporation had not been dissolved;

(b) a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding may be brought against the corporation as if the corporation had not been dissolved;

(c) any property that would have been available to satisfy any judgment or order if the corporation had not been dissolved remains available for such purpose; and

(d) title to land belonging to the corporation immediately before the dissolution remains available to be sold in power of sale proceedings.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 242 (1); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 27 (1, 2).

Interpretation

(1.1) In this section and section 244,

“proceeding” includes a power of sale proceeding relating to land commenced pursuant to a mortgage.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 27 (3).

Service after dissolution

(2) For the purposes of this section, the service of any process on a corporation after its dissolution shall be deemed to be sufficiently made if it is made upon any person last shown on the records of the Ministry as being a director or officer of the corporation before the dissolution.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 242 (2).

Notice of action

(3) A person who commences an action, suit or other proceeding against a corporation after its dissolution, shall serve the writ or other document by which the action, suit or other proceeding was commenced, on the Public Guardian and Trustee in accordance with the rules that apply generally to service on a party to an action, suit or other proceeding.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 27 (4).

Same, power of sale proceeding

(4) A person who commences a power of sale proceeding relating to land against a corporation after its dissolution shall serve a notice of the proceeding on the Public Guardian and Trustee in accordance with the notice requirements in the Mortgages Act that apply with respect to a person with an interest in the land recorded in the records of the appropriate land registry office.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 27 (4).

Liability of shareholders to creditors

243. (1) Despite the dissolution of a corporation, each shareholder to whom any of its property has been distributed is liable to any person claiming under section 242 to the extent of the amount received by that shareholder upon the distribution, and an action to enforce such liability may be brought.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 243 (1); 2002, c. 24, Sched. B, s. 27 (2).

Party action

(2) The court may order an action referred to in subsection (1) to be brought against the persons who were shareholders as a class, subject to such conditions as the court thinks fit and, if the plaintiff establishes his, her or its claim, the court may refer the proceedings to a referee or other officer of the court who may,

(a) add as a party to the proceedings before him or her each person who was a shareholder found by the plaintiff;

(b) determine, subject to subsection (1), the amount that each person who was a shareholder shall contribute towards satisfaction of the plaintiff’s claim; and

(c) direct payment of the amounts so determined.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 243 (2).

Definition

(3) In this section,

“shareholder” includes the heirs and legal representatives of a shareholder.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 243 (3).

Forfeiture of undisposed property

244. (1) Any property of a corporation that has not been disposed of at the date of its dissolution is immediately upon such dissolution forfeit to and vests in the Crown.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 244 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (31).

Exception

(2) Despite subsection (1), if a judgment is given or an order or decision is made or land is sold in an action, suit or proceeding commenced in accordance with section 242 and the judgment, order, decision or sale affects property belonging to the corporation before the dissolution, unless the plaintiff, applicant or mortgagee has not complied with subsection 242 (3) or (4),

(a) the property shall be available to satisfy the judgment, order or other decision; and

(b) title to the land shall be transferred to a purchaser free of the Crown’s interest, in the case of a power of sale proceeding.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 28 (1).

Further exception

(3) A forfeiture of land under subsection (1) or a predecessor of subsection (1) is not effective against a purchaser for value of the land if the forfeiture occurred more than 20 years before the deed or transfer of the purchaser is registered in the proper land registry office.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (32).

No notice

(4) Despite subsection (2), if a person commences a power of sale proceeding relating to land before the dissolution of a corporation but the sale of the land is not completed until after the dissolution, the person is not required to serve the notice mentioned in subsection 242 (4) and title to the land may be transferred to a purchaser free of the Crown’s interest.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 28 (2).

PART XVII
REMEDIES, OFFENCES AND PENALTIES

Definitions

245. In this Part,

“action” means an action under this Act; (“action”)

“complainant” means,

(a) a registered holder or beneficial owner, and a former registered holder or beneficial owner, of a security of a corporation or any of its affiliates,

(b) a director or an officer or a former director or officer of a corporation or of any of its affiliates,

(c) any other person who, in the discretion of the court, is a proper person to make an application under this Part. (“plaignant”)  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 245.

Derivative actions

246. (1) Subject to subsection (2), a complainant may apply to the court for leave to bring an action in the name and on behalf of a corporation or any of its subsidiaries, or intervene in an action to which any such body corporate is a party, for the purpose of prosecuting, defending or discontinuing the action on behalf of the body corporate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 246 (1).

Idem

(2) No action may be brought and no intervention in an action may be made under subsection (1) unless the complainant has given fourteen days’ notice to the directors of the corporation or its subsidiary of the complainant’s intention to apply to the court under subsection (1) and the court is satisfied that,

(a) the directors of the corporation or its subsidiary will not bring, diligently prosecute or defend or discontinue the action;

(b) the complainant is acting in good faith; and

(c) it appears to be in the interests of the corporation or its subsidiary that the action be brought, prosecuted, defended or discontinued.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 246 (2).

Application

(3) Where a complainant on an application made without notice can establish to the satisfaction of the court that it is not expedient to give notice as required under subsection (2), the court may make such interim order as it thinks fit pending the complainant giving notice as required.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 246 (3).

Interim order

(4) Where a complainant on an application can establish to the satisfaction of the court that an interim order for relief should be made, the court may make such order as it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 246 (4).

Court order

247. In connection with an action brought or intervened in under section 246, the court may at any time make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order authorizing the complainant or any other person to control the conduct of the action;

(b) an order giving directions for the conduct of the action;

(c) an order directing that any amount adjudged payable by a defendant in the action shall be paid, in whole or in part, directly to former and present security holders of the corporation or its subsidiary instead of to the corporation or its subsidiary; and

(d) an order requiring the corporation or its subsidiary to pay reasonable legal fees and any other costs reasonably incurred by the complainant in connection with the action.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 247.

Oppression remedy

248. (1) A complainant and, in the case of an offering corporation, the Commission may apply to the court for an order under this section.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (33).

Idem

(2) Where, upon an application under subsection (1), the court is satisfied that in respect of a corporation or any of its affiliates,

(a) any act or omission of the corporation or any of its affiliates effects or threatens to effect a result;

(b) the business or affairs of the corporation or any of its affiliates are, have been or are threatened to be carried on or conducted in a manner; or

(c) the powers of the directors of the corporation or any of its affiliates are, have been or are threatened to be exercised in a manner,

that is oppressive or unfairly prejudicial to or that unfairly disregards the interests of any security holder, creditor, director or officer of the corporation, the court may make an order to rectify the matters complained of.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 248 (2).

Court order

(3) In connection with an application under this section, the court may make any interim or final order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order restraining the conduct complained of;

(b) an order appointing a receiver or receiver-manager;

(c) an order to regulate a corporation’s affairs by amending the articles or by-laws or creating or amending a unanimous shareholder agreement;

(d) an order directing an issue or exchange of securities;

(e) an order appointing directors in place of or in addition to all or any of the directors then in office;

(f) an order directing a corporation, subject to subsection (6), or any other person, to purchase securities of a security holder;

(g) an order directing a corporation, subject to subsection (6), or any other person, to pay to a security holder any part of the money paid by the security holder for securities;

(h) an order varying or setting aside a transaction or contract to which a corporation is a party and compensating the corporation or any other party to the transaction or contract;

(i) an order requiring a corporation, within a time specified by the court, to produce to the court or an interested person financial statements in the form required by section 154 or an accounting in such other form as the court may determine;

(j) an order compensating an aggrieved person;

(k) an order directing rectification of the registers or other records of a corporation under section 250;

(l) an order winding up the corporation under section 207;

(m) an order directing an investigation under Part XIII be made; and

(n) an order requiring the trial of any issue.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 248 (3).

Idem

(4) Where an order made under this section directs amendment of the articles or by-laws of a corporation,

(a) the directors shall forthwith comply with subsection 186 (4); and

(b) no other amendment to the articles or by-laws shall be made without the consent of the court, until the court otherwise orders.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 248 (4).

Shareholder may not dissent

(5) A shareholder is not entitled to dissent under section 185 if an amendment to the articles is effected under this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 248 (5).

Where corporation prohibited from paying shareholder

(6) A corporation shall not make a payment to a shareholder under clause (3) (f) or (g) if there are reasonable grounds for believing that,

(a) the corporation is or, after the payment, would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or

(b) the realizable value of the corporation’s assets would thereby be less than the aggregate of its liabilities.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 248 (6).

Discontinuance and settlement

249. (1) An application made or an action brought or intervened in under this Part shall not be stayed or dismissed by reason only that it is shown that an alleged breach of a right or duty owed to the corporation or its affiliate has been or may be approved by the shareholders of such body corporate, but evidence of approval by the shareholders may be taken into account by the court in making an order under section 207, 247 or 248.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 249 (1).

Idem

(2) An application made or an action brought or intervened in under this Part shall not be stayed, discontinued, settled or dismissed for want of prosecution without the approval of the court given upon such terms as the court thinks fit and, if the court determines that the interests of any complainant may be substantially affected by such stay, discontinuance, settlement or dismissal, the court may order any party to the application or action to give notice to the complainant.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 249 (2).

Costs

(3) A complainant is not required to give security for costs in any application made or action brought or intervened in under this Part.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 249 (3).

Idem

(4) In an application made or an action brought or intervened in under this Part, the court may at any time order the corporation or its affiliate to pay to the complainant interim costs, including reasonable legal fees and disbursements, for which interim costs the complainant may be held accountable to the corporation or its affiliate upon final disposition of the application or action.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 249 (4).

Rectifying error in entering, etc., name

250. (1) Where the name of a person is alleged to be or have been wrongly entered or retained in, or wrongly deleted or wrongly omitted from, the registers or other records of a corporation, the corporation, a security holder of the corporation or any aggrieved person may apply to the court for an order that the registers or records be rectified.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 250 (1).

Idem

(2) In connection with an application under this section, the court may make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order requiring the registers or other records of the corporation to be rectified;

(b) an order restraining the corporation from calling or holding a meeting of shareholders or paying a dividend or making any other distribution or payment to shareholders before the rectification;

(c) an order determining the right of a party to the proceedings to have the party’s name entered or retained in, or deleted or omitted from, the registers or records of the corporation, whether the issue arises between two or more security holders, or between the corporation and any security holders or alleged security holders;

(d) an order compensating a party who has incurred a loss.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 250 (2).

Notice of refusal to file

251. (1) Where the Director refuses to endorse a certificate on articles or any other document required by this Act to be endorsed with a certificate by the Director before it becomes effective, the Director shall give written notice to the person who delivered the articles or other document of the Director’s refusal, specifying the reasons therefor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 251 (1).

Failure to act deemed refusal

(2) Where, within six months after the delivery to the Director of articles or other documents referred to in subsection (1), the Director has not endorsed a certificate on such articles or other document, the Director shall be deemed for the purposes of section 252 to have refused to endorse it.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 251 (2).

Appeal from Director

252. (1) A person aggrieved by a decision of the Director,

(a) to refuse to endorse a certificate on articles or on any other document;

(b) to issue or to refuse to issue a certificate of amendment under section 12;

(c) to refuse to grant an order under section 144;

(d) to grant or refuse to grant exemption under section 148;

(e) to refuse to endorse an authorization under section 181; or

(f) to issue an order under section 240,

may appeal to the Divisional Court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 252 (1).

Form of appeal

(2) Every appeal shall be by notice of appeal sent by registered mail to the Director within thirty days after the mailing of the notice of the decision.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 252 (2).

Certificate of Director

(3) The Director shall certify to the Divisional Court,

(a) the decision of the Director together with a statement of the reasons therefor;

(b) the record of any hearing; and

(c) all written submissions to the Director or other material that is relevant to the appeal.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 252 (3).

Representation

(4) The Director is entitled to be heard, by counsel or otherwise, upon the argument of an appeal under this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 252 (4).

Court order

(5) Where an appeal is taken under this section, the court may by its order direct the Director to make such decision or to do such other act as the Director is authorized and empowered to do under this Act and as the court thinks proper, having regard to the material and submissions before it and to this Act, and the Director shall make such decision or do such act accordingly.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 252 (5).

Director may make further decision

(6) Despite an order of the court under subsection (5), the Director has power to make any further decision upon new material or where there is a material change in the circumstances, and every such decision is subject to this section.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 252 (6).

Orders for compliance

253. (1) Where a corporation or any shareholder, director, officer, employee, agent, auditor, trustee, receiver and manager, receiver, or liquidator of a corporation does not comply with this Act, the regulations, articles, by-laws, or a unanimous shareholder agreement, a complainant or a creditor of the corporation may, despite the imposition of any penalty in respect of such non-compliance and in addition to any other right the complainant or creditor has, apply to the court for an order directing the corporation or any person to comply with, or restraining the corporation or any person from acting in breach of, any provisions thereof, and upon such application the court may so order and make any further order it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 253 (1).

Idem

(2) Where it appears to the Commission that any person to whom section 111 or subsection 112 (1) applies has failed to comply with or is contravening either or both of such provisions, despite the imposition of any penalty in respect of such non-compliance or contravention, the Commission may apply to the court and the court may, upon such application, make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,

(a) an order restraining a solicitation, the holding of a meeting or any person from implementing or acting upon any resolution passed at a meeting, to which such non-compliance with or contravention of section 111 or subsection 112 (1) relates;

(b) an order requiring correction of any form of proxy or information circular and a further solicitation; or

(c) an order adjourning the meeting to which such non-compliance with or contravention of section 111 or subsection 112 (1) relates.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 253 (2).

Application made without notice

254. Where this Act states that a person may apply to the court, that person may apply for injunctive relief without notice as the rules of the court provide.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 254.

Appeal

255. An appeal lies to the Divisional Court from any order made by the court under this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 255.

Offences

256. (1) In this section,

“misrepresentation” means,

(a) an untrue statement of material fact, or

(b) an omission to state a material fact that is required to be stated or that is necessary to make a statement not misleading in the light of the circumstances in which it was made.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 256 (1).

Offence, false statements, etc.

(2) Every person who,

(a) makes or assists in making a statement in any material, evidence or information submitted or given under this Act or the regulations to the Director, the Director’s delegate or the Commission or any person appointed to make an investigation or audit under this Act that, at the time and in the light of the circumstances under which it is made, is a misrepresentation;

(b) makes or assists in making a statement in any application, articles, consent, financial statement, information circular, notice, report or other document required to be filed with, furnished or sent to the Director or the Commission under this Act or the regulations that, at the time and in the light of the circumstances under which it is made, is a misrepresentation;

(c) fails to file with the Director or the Commission any document required by this Act to be filed with the Director or the Commission; or

(d) fails to observe or to comply with any direction, decision, ruling, order or other requirement made by the Director or the Commission under this Act or the regulations,

is guilty of an offence and on conviction is liable to a fine of not more than $2,000 or to imprisonment for a term of not more than one year, or to both, or, if such person is a body corporate, to a fine of not more than $25,000.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 256 (2).

Idem

(3) Where a body corporate is guilty of an offence under subsection (2), every director or officer of such body corporate who, without reasonable cause, authorized, permitted or acquiesced in the offence is also guilty of an offence and on conviction is liable to a fine of not more than $2,000 or to imprisonment for a term of not more than one year, or to both.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 256 (3).

Defence

(4) No person is guilty of an offence under clause (2) (a) or (b) if the person did not know and in the exercise of reasonable diligence could not have known that the statement was a misrepresentation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 256 (4).

Consent

257. No proceeding under section 256 shall be commenced except with the consent or under the direction of the Minister.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 257.

Offence

258. (1) Every person who,

(a) fails without reasonable cause to comply with subsection 29 (5);

(b) without reasonable cause uses a list of holders of securities in contravention of subsection 52 (5) or subsection 146 (8);

(c) fails without reasonable cause to send a prescribed form of proxy to each shareholder of an offering corporation with notice of a meeting of shareholders in contravention of section 111;

(d) fails without reasonable cause to send an information circular in connection with a proxy solicitation in contravention of subsection 112 (1);

(e) being a proxyholder or alternate proxyholder, fails, without reasonable cause, to comply with the directions of the shareholder who appointed him or her in contravention of subsection 114 (1);

(f) without reasonable cause contravenes section 145;

(g) being a director of a corporation, fails, without reasonable cause, to appoint an auditor or auditors, as the case may be, under subsection 149 (1);

(h) being an auditor or former auditor of a corporation fails without reasonable cause to comply with subsection 151 (2);

(i) fails without reasonable cause to comply with subsection 154 (1); or

(j) otherwise without reasonable cause commits an act contrary to or fails or neglects to comply with any provision of this Act or the regulations,

is guilty of an offence and on conviction is liable to a fine of not more than $2,000 or to imprisonment for a term of not more than one year, or to both, or if such person is a body corporate, to a fine of not more than $25,000.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 258 (1).

Idem

(2) Where a body corporate is guilty of an offence under subsection (1), every director or officer of such body corporate who, without reasonable cause, authorized, permitted or acquiesced in such offence is also guilty of an offence and on conviction is liable to a fine of not more than $2,000 or to imprisonment for a term of not more than one year, or to both.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 258 (2).

Limitation

259. (1) No proceeding under section 256 or under clause 258 (1) (j) for a contravention of section 144 shall be commenced more than two years after the facts upon which the proceedings are based first came to the knowledge of the Director as certified by him or her.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 259 (1).

Idem

(2) Subject to subsection (1), no proceeding for an offence under this Act or the regulations shall be commenced more than two years after the time when the subject-matter of the offence arose.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 259 (2).

Information containing more than one offence

260. An information in respect of any contravention of this Act may be for one or more offences and no information, summons, warrant, conviction or other proceeding in any prosecution is objectionable as insufficient by reason of the fact that it relates to two or more offences.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 260.

Civil remedy not affected

261. No civil remedy for an act or omission is suspended or affected by reason that the act or omission is an offence under this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 261.

PART XVIII
GENERAL

Notice to directors or shareholders

262. (1) A notice or document required by this Act, the regulations, the articles or the by-laws to be sent to a shareholder or director of a corporation may be sent by prepaid mail addressed to, or may be delivered personally to,

(a) a shareholder at the shareholder’s latest address as shown in the records of the corporation or its transfer agent; and

(b) a director at his or her latest address as shown in the records of the corporation or in the most recent notice filed under the Corporations Information Act, whichever is the more current.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 262 (1).

Idem

(2) A notice or document sent in accordance with subsection (1) to a shareholder or director of a corporation is deemed to be received by the addressee on the fifth day after mailing.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 262 (2).

Director

(3) A director named in the articles or the most recent return or notice filed under the Corporations Information Act, or a predecessor thereof, is presumed for the purposes of this Act to be a director of the corporation referred to in the articles, return or notice.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 262 (3).

Where notice returned

(4) Where a corporation sends a notice or document to a shareholder in accordance with subsection (1) and the notice or document is returned on three consecutive occasions because the shareholder cannot be found, the corporation is not required to send any further notices or documents to the shareholder until the shareholder informs the corporation in writing of the shareholder’s new address.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 262 (4).

Application to court

(5) Where it is impracticable or impossible to comply with subsection (1), a person may apply to the court for such order as the court thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 262 (5).

Notice to corporation

263. (1) Except where otherwise provided in this Act, a notice or document required to be sent to a corporation may be sent to the corporation by prepaid mail at its registered office as shown on the records of the Director or may be delivered personally to the corporation at such office and shall be deemed to be received by the corporation on the fifth day after mailing.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 263.

Exception

(2) A notice or other document that is required or permitted by this Act or the regulations to be sent by the Director may be sent by ordinary mail or by any other method, including registered mail, certified mail or prepaid courier, to an address referred to in section 262 or 263 if there is a record by the person who has delivered it that the notice or document has been sent.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (34).

Same

(3) A notice or other document referred to in subsection (2) may be sent by telephone transmission of a facsimile of the notice or other document or by any other form of electronic transmission if there is a record that the notice or other document has been sent.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (34).

Deemed delivery

(4) A notice or other document sent by mail by the Director shall be deemed to have been received by the intended recipient on the earlier of,

(a) the day the intended recipient actually receives it; or

(b) the fifth business day after the day it is mailed.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (34).

Same

(5) A notice or other document sent by a method referred to in subsection (3) shall be deemed to have been received by the intended recipient on the earlier of,

(a) the day the intended recipient actually receives it; or

(b) the first business day after the day the transmission is sent by the Director.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (34).

Waiver of notice and abridgement of times

264. Where a notice or document is required by this Act or the regulations to be sent, the notice may be waived or the time for the sending of the notice or document may be waived or abridged at any time with the consent in writing of the person entitled thereto.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 264.

Delegation of powers and duties

265. (1) The Director may delegate in writing any of the Director’s duties or powers under this Act to any public servant in the Ministry.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 265 (1).

Execution of certificate of Director

(2) Where this Act requires or authorizes the Director to endorse or issue a certificate or to certify any fact, the certificate shall be signed by the Director or any other person designated by the regulations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 265 (2).

Certificate as evidence

(3) A certificate referred to in subsection (2) or a certified copy thereof, when introduced as evidence in any civil, criminal, or administrative action or proceeding, is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, proof of the facts so certified without personal appearance to prove the signature or official position of the person appearing to have signed the certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 265 (3).

Mechanical reproduction of signature

(4) For the purposes of subsections (2) and (3), any signature of the Director or any signature of an officer of the Ministry designated by the regulations may be printed or otherwise mechanically reproduced.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 265 (4).

Non-application

(5) Subsections (2), (3) and (4) do not apply to certificates which are in electronic form.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (35).

Certificate that may be signed by directors, etc.

266. (1) A certificate issued on behalf of a corporation stating any fact that is set out in the articles, the by-laws, a unanimous shareholder agreement, the minutes of the meetings of the directors, a committee of directors or the shareholders, or a trust indenture or other contract to which the corporation is a party, may be signed by a director, an officer or a transfer agent of the corporation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 266 (1).

Evidence being proof

(2) When introduced as evidence in any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding,

(a) a fact stated in a certificate referred to in subsection (1);

(b) a certified extract from a register of a corporation required to be maintained by this Act; or

(c) a certified copy of minutes or extract from minutes of a meeting of shareholders, directors or a committee of directors of a corporation,

is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, proof of the facts so certified without proof of the signature or official character of the person appearing to have signed the certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 266 (2).

Idem

(3) An entry in a securities register of, or a security certificate issued by, a corporation is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, proof that the person in whose name the security is registered or whose name appears on the certificate is the owner of the securities described in the register or in the certificate, as the case may be.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 266 (3).

Copy of document acceptable

267. (1) Where a notice or document is required to be sent to the Director under this Act, the Director may accept a photostatic or photographic copy thereof.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 267 (1).

Exception to subs. (1)

(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to articles, applications or documents filed under subsection 9 (3).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 267 (2).

Proof by affidavit

268. (1) The Director may require any fact relevant to the performance of the Director’s duties under this Act or the regulations to be verified by affidavit or otherwise.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 268 (1).

Oaths and affirmations at hearings

(2) For the purpose of holding a hearing under this Act, the Director may administer oaths and affirmations to witnesses and require them to give evidence under oath or affirmation.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 268 (2).

269. Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (36).

Examination, etc., of documents

270. (1) A person who has paid the required fee is entitled during usual business hours to examine and to make copies of or extracts from any document required by this Act or the regulations to be sent to the Director or the Commission, except a report sent to the Director under subsection 162 (2) that the court has ordered not to be made available to the public.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 270 (1); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 29.

Copies to be furnished

(2) Subject to clause 162 (1) (j), the Director or the Commission shall furnish any person with a copy or a certified copy of a document required by this Act or the regulations to be sent to the Director or the Commission.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 270 (2).

Privileged documents

(3) Subsections (1) and (2) do not apply in respect of documents and financial statements required, by this Act or the regulations, to be filed with the Director with an application for exemption from the requirements of Part XII of this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 270 (3).

Appeal from Commission

271. Any person aggrieved by a decision of the Commission under this Act may appeal the decision to the Divisional Court and subsections 9 (2) to (6) of the Securities Act apply to the appeal.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 271.

Powers of Minister

271.1 (1) The Minister may make regulations,

(a) prescribing forms for use under this Act and providing for their use;

(b) prescribing the form and content of any notices or documents that this Act requires to be filed.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 30.

Fees

(2) The Minister may by order require the payment of fees for search reports, copies of documents or information, filing of documents or other services under this Act and may approve the amount of those fees.  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 30.

Regulations

272. The Lieutenant Governor in Council may make regulations respecting any matter the Lieutenant Governor in Council considers necessary for the purposes of this Act including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, regulations,

1. respecting names of corporations or classes thereof, the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attaching to shares or classes of shares of corporations, or any other matter pertaining to articles or the filing thereof;

2. Repealed:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (1).

3. Repealed:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (1).

4. Repealed:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (1).

Note:  Despite the repeal of paragraph 2, regulations made under paragraph 2, as that paragraph read immediately before March 1, 1999, continue until the Minister makes an order under subsection 271.1 (2), as enacted by the Statutes of Ontario, 1998, chapter 18, Schedule E, section 30, that is inconsistent with those regulations.  See:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (2).

Note:  Despite the repeal of paragraph 2, the Lieutenant Governor in Council may by regulation revoke regulations made under paragraph 2, as that paragraph read immediately before March 1, 1999, if the Minister makes an order under subsection 271.1 (2), as enacted by the Statutes of Ontario, 1998, chapter 18, Schedule E, section 30, that is inconsistent with those regulations.  See:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (3).

Note:  Despite the repeal of paragraphs 3 and 4, the Lieutenant Governor in Council may by regulation revoke regulations made under paragraph 3 or 4, as those paragraphs read immediately before March 1, 1999, if the Minister makes a regulation under subsection 271.1 (1), as enacted by the Statutes of Ontario, 1998, chapter 18, Schedule E, section 30, that is inconsistent with those regulations.  See:  1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (4).

5. designating officers of the Ministry for the purposes of endorsing certificates, issuing certificates as to any fact or certifying true copies of documents required or authorized under this Act;

6. prescribing the form and content of information circulars and proxies required by Part VIII and the discretionary authority that may be conferred in proxies;

7. prescribing requirements with respect to applications to the Director or the Commission for exemptions permitted by this Act and the practice and procedure thereon;

8. prohibiting the use of any words or expressions in a corporate name;

9. defining any word or expression used in clause 9 (1) (b);

10. prescribing requirements for the purposes of clause 9 (1) (c);

11. prescribing conditions for the purposes of subsection 9 (2);

12. prescribing the documents relating to names that shall be filed with the Director under subsection 9 (3);

13. respecting the name of a corporation under subsection 10 (2);

14. prescribing the punctuation marks and other marks that may form part of a corporate name under subsection 10 (3);

15. respecting the content of a special language provision under subsection 10 (4);

16. prescribing the form of the statutory declarations under subsection 52 (1) and subsection 146 (1);

16.1 prescribing an amount for the purposes of subclause 148 (1) (a) (iii);

17. prescribing the form and content of financial statements and interim financial statements required under this Act;

18. prescribing that, for the purposes of Part XII of this Act, the standards, as they exist from time to time, of a prescribed accounting body shall be followed;

19. prescribing standards to be used by an auditor in making an examination of financial statements required under this Act and the manner in which the auditor shall report thereon;

20. prescribing exceptions under section 177;

21. prescribing the manner in which notice may be sent under subsection 190 (3);

22. prescribing the requirements with respect to applications by the Director authorized under subsection 248 (1);

23. prescribing Acts of Canada or a province or ordinances of a territory for purposes of sections 29, 42, 45 and 56 and prescribing the notice required under subsection 45 (1);

24. prescribing the manner in which the directors of corporations may determine that restricted shares are owned contrary to restrictions under subsection 45 (1);

25. prescribing the manner in which funds may be invested under subsection 45 (5);

26. prescribing, with respect to a corporation that has imposed restrictions on the issue, transfer or ownership of its shares for a purpose under subsection 42 (2),

i. the disclosure required of the restrictions in documents issued or published by the corporation,

ii. the duties and powers of the directors to refuse to issue or register transfers of shares in accordance with the articles of the corporation,

iii. the limitations on voting rights of any shares held contrary to the articles of the corporation, and

iv. the powers of the directors to require disclosure of beneficial ownership of shares of the corporation and the rights of the corporation and its directors, employees or agents to rely on the disclosure and the effects of the reliance;

27. prescribing persons or classes of persons for the purpose of clause 42 (2) (c) and prescribing the manner of computing the ownership of shares of a corporation by persons for such purpose;

28. prescribing the circumstances and conditions under which the Director may exercise power under subsection 148 (2);

29. prescribing classes of persons for the purposes of clause (b) of the definition of “resident Canadian” in subsection 1 (1);

29.1 providing for and governing the filing of documents sent by electronic format, including the manner of determining the date of receipt and the form of electronic signatures;

29.2 providing for the waiver of signature requirements;

29.3 providing for the exclusion of any class or classes of documents from being filed in electronic format or by telephone transmission of a facsimile;

29.4 authorizing the Director to enter into an agreement with any person respecting the use, disclosure, sale or licensing of records required under this Act and prescribing terms and conditions for any such agreement;

30. prescribing any matter referred to in this Act as prescribed by the regulations.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 272; 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (37); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 31 (1).

Where articles to be sent to Director

273. (1) Where this Act requires that articles relating to a corporation be sent to the Director, unless otherwise specifically provided,

(a) two duplicate originals of the articles shall be signed by a director or an officer of the corporation or, in the case of articles of incorporation, by an incorporator; and

(b) upon receiving duplicate originals of any articles in the prescribed form that have been executed in accordance with this Act, any other required documents and the prescribed fees, the Director shall, subject to his or her discretion as provided in subsection 180 (4) and subsection 241 (5), and, subject to subsection (2),

(i) endorse on each duplicate original a certificate, setting out the day, month and year of endorsement and the corporation number,

(ii) file a copy of the articles with the endorsement of the certificate thereon, and

(iii) send to the corporation or its representative one duplicate original of the articles with the endorsement of the certificate thereon.

(iv) Repealed:  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (38).

R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 273 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (38).

Date on certificate

(2) A certificate referred to in subsection (1) shall be dated as of the day the Director receives the duplicate originals of any articles together with all other required documents executed in accordance with this Act and the required fee, or as of any later date acceptable to the Director and specified by the person who submitted the articles or by the court.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 273 (2); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 32 (1).

Effective date of articles

(3) Articles endorsed with a certificate under subsection (1), are effective on the date shown in the certificate even if any action required to be taken by the Director under this Act with respect to the endorsement of the certificate and filing by the Director is taken at a later date.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 273 (3).

Electronic filing

(4) Despite subsections (1) and (2), if articles relating to a corporation are sent to the Director in a prescribed electronic format,

(a) the articles shall set out an electronic signature of a director or officer of the corporation or, in the case of articles of incorporation, the electronic signature of the incorporator, unless the regulations otherwise provide; and

(b) upon receipt of the articles in the prescribed electronic format completed in accordance with this Act and the required fee, the Director shall, subject to his or her discretion as provided in subsections 180 (4) and 241 (5), and subject to subsection (5) of this section,

(i) endorse a certificate by making an appropriate entry in an electronic database maintained under section 276, and

(ii) send to the corporation or its representative a copy of the certificate in a form prescribed by the regulations.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (39); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 32 (2).

Date of certificate

(5) A certificate referred to in subsection (4) shall be dated as of the day the Director received the articles in a prescribed electronic format completed in accordance with this Act and the required fee or as of any later date acceptable to the Director and specified by the person who submitted the articles or by the court.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (39); 1998, c. 18, Sched. E, s. 32 (3).

Electronic filers

273.1 (1) Information that is filed in an electronic format may be filed by a person who is authorized to do so by the Director or by a person who is a member of a class of persons that is authorized to do so.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (40).

Condition

(2) The Director may attach terms and conditions to an authorization given under subsection (1) and may require any person who applies for an authorization to enter into an agreement governing the making of filings in an electronic format.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (40).

Fax filing

273.2 (1) Despite section 273 and subject to the regulations, articles or other documents may be sent in duplicate to the Director by telephone transmission of a facsimile.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (40).

Same

(2) Where articles or another document are sent to the Director under subsection (1), a required signature may be a facsimile.  1994, c. 27, s. 71 (40).

No certificate if corporation in default

274. (1) Despite any provision of this Act requiring the Director to endorse a certificate, the Director shall not do so if a corporation is in default of a filing requirement under the Corporations Information Act or has any unpaid fees or penalties outstanding.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 274 (1).

Commencement

(2) This section comes into force on a day to be named by proclamation of the Lieutenant Governor.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 274 (2).

Where error in respect of certificate

275. (1) Where a certificate endorsed or issued under this Act or a predecessor of this Act contains an error or where a certificate has been endorsed or issued on articles or any other documents that contain an error,

(a) the corporation, its directors or shareholders may apply to the Director for a corrected certificate and shall surrender the certificate and related articles or documents; or

(b) the corporation shall upon the request of the Director surrender the certificate and related articles or documents,

and, after giving the corporation an opportunity to be heard, where the Director is of the opinion that it is appropriate to so do and is satisfied that such steps have been taken by the corporation as the Director required, the Director shall endorse a corrected certificate.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 275 (1).

Date on certificate

(2) A corrected certificate endorsed under subsection (1) may bear the date of the certificate it replaces.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 275 (2).

Material amendment

(3) Where a correction made under subsection (1) is material, the Director shall forthwith give notice of the correction in The Ontario Gazette in accordance with section 269.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 275 (3).

Appeal

(4) A decision of the Director under subsection (1) may be appealed to the Divisional Court which may order the Director to change his or her decision and make such further order as it thinks fit.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 275 (4).

Records

276. (1) Records required by this Act to be prepared and maintained by the Director or Commission may be in bound or loose-leaf or electronic form or in photographic film form, or may be entered or recorded by any system of mechanical or electronic data processing or by any other information storage device that is capable of reproducing any required information in an accurate and intelligible form within a reasonable time.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 276 (1); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (41).

Admission as evidence

(2) When records maintained by the Director or the Commission are prepared and maintained other than in written form,

(a) the Director or the Commission shall furnish any copy required to be furnished under subsection 270 (2) in intelligible written or other form; and

(b) a report reproduced from those records, if it is certified by the Director or the Commission or a member thereof, as the case may be, is, without proof of the office or signature thereof, admissible in evidence.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 276 (2); 1994, c. 27, s. 71 (42, 43).

Copy in lieu of document

(3) The Director or Commission, as the case may be, is not required to produce any document where a copy of the document is furnished in compliance with clause (2) (a).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 276 (3).

Deemed amendment

277. (1) Any provision in articles, by-laws or any special resolution of a corporation that was valid immediately before the 29th day of July, 1983 and that has not been amended in accordance with this Act is deemed to be amended to the extent necessary to bring the terms of the provision into conformity with this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 277 (1).

Amendments

(2) A corporation may, by articles of amendment, change the express terms of any provision in its articles to which subsection (1) applies to conform to the terms of the provision as deemed to be amended by that subsection.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 277 (2).

Idem

(3) A corporation shall not restate its articles under section 173 unless the articles of the corporation are in conformity with this Act and, where the articles have been deemed to be amended under subsection (1), the corporation has amended the express terms of the provisions in its articles in accordance with subsection (2).  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 277 (3).

Where s. 185 does not apply

(4) A shareholder is not entitled to dissent under section 185 in respect of any amendment made for the purpose only of bringing the provisions of articles into conformity with this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 277 (4).

Appointment of Director

278. The Minister may appoint a Director to carry out the duties and exercise the powers of the Director under this Act.  R.S.O. 1990, c. B.16, s. 278.